ARM|Driver: Add DPI Driver for emulation
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
509 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
510 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
511 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
512 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
513
514 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
515 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
516 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
517
518 @section USB Other
519 @itemize @bullet
520 @item @b{USBprog}
521 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
522
523 @item @b{USB - Presto}
524 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
525
526 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
527 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
528
529 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
530 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
531
532 @item @b{Buspirate}
533 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
534
535 @item @b{opendous}
536 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
537
538 @item @b{estick}
539 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
540
541 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
543
544 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
546 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
547 @end itemize
548
549 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
550
551 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
552 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
553 these on the market.
554
555 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
556 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
557 of USB-based ones.
558
559 @itemize @bullet
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
563
564 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
565 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
566 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
567
568 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
569 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
570
571 @item @b{Wiggler2}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
573
574 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
575 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
576
577 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
578 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
579
580 @item @b{arm-jtag}
581 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
582
583 @item @b{chameleon}
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
585
586 @item @b{Triton}
587 @* Unknown.
588
589 @item @b{Lattice}
590 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
591 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
592
593 @item @b{flashlink}
594 @* From STMicroelectronics;
595 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
596
597 @end itemize
598
599 @section Other...
600 @itemize @bullet
601
602 @item @b{ep93xx}
603 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
604
605 @item @b{at91rm9200}
606 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
607
608 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
609 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
610
611 @item @b{imx_gpio}
612 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
613
614 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
615 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
616 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
617
618 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
619 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
620 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
621 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
622 emulation model of target hardware.
623
624 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
625 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
626
627 @end itemize
628
629 @node About Jim-Tcl
630 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
631 @cindex Jim-Tcl
632 @cindex tcl
633
634 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
635 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
636 command interpreter.
637
638 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
639 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
640 much of anything about Tcl.
641 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
642
643 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
644 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
645 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
646 OpenOCD mailing list.
647
648 @itemize @bullet
649 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
650 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
651 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
652 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
653 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
654 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
655
656 @item @b{Missing Features}
657 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
658 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
659 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
660 enabled in OpenOCD.
661
662 @item @b{Scripts}
663 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
664 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
665 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
666
667 @item @b{Commands}
668 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
669 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
670 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
671 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
672
673 @item @b{Historical Note}
674 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
675 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
676 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
677 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
678
679 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
680 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
681 @end itemize
682
683 @node Running
684 @chapter Running
685 @cindex command line options
686 @cindex logfile
687 @cindex directory search
688
689 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
690 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
691 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
692 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
693 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
694 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
695 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
696
697 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
698 tell it how each debug session should work.
699 The @option{--help} option shows:
700 @verbatim
701 bash$ openocd --help
702
703 --help | -h display this help
704 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
705 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
706 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
707 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
708 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
709 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
710 --command | -c run <command>
711 @end verbatim
712
713 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
714 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
715 To specify one or more different
716 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
717
718 @example
719 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
720 @end example
721
722 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
723 @enumerate
724 @item the current directory,
725 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
726 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
727 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
728 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
729 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
730 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
731 @end enumerate
732 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
733
734 @quotation Note
735 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
736 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
737 @end quotation
738
739 @section Simple setup, no customization
740
741 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
742 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
743 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
744 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
745 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
746
747 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
748 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
749 the server with some variation of one of the following:
750
751 @example
752 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
753 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
754 @end example
755
756 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
757 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
758 If all goes well you'll see output something like
759
760 @example
761 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
762 For bug reports, read
763 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
764 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
765 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
766 @end example
767
768 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
769 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
770 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
771
772 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
773
774 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
775 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
776 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
777 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
778 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
779 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
780 ensure that this always succeeds.
781 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
782 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
783 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
784 and then shut down without acting as a server.
785
786 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
787 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
788 those channels.
789
790 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
791 the @option{-d} option.
792
793 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
794 @option{-c} command line switch.
795
796 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
797 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
798 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
799 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
800 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
801 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
802 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
803
804 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
805 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
806
807 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
808 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
809 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
810 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
811
812 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
813 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
814
815 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
816 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
817 and start the OpenOCD server.
818 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
819 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
820 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
821 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
822
823 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
824
825 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
826 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
827 and a USB cable on the other.
828 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
829 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
830
831 @enumerate
832 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
833 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
834 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
835 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
836 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
837 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
838 debugging host.
839
840 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
841 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
842 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
843 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
844 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
845
846 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
847 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
848 with 1.2 Volt boards.
849
850 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
851 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
852 ways to connect the cable.
853 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
854 Be sure it's firmly connected.
855
856 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
857 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
858 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
859 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
860 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
861 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
862 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
863 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
864
865 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
866 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
867 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
868 but are tedious to set up.
869 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
870 adapter signals to the right board pins.
871
872 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
873 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
874 you are using to run OpenOCD.
875 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
876
877 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
878 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
879 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
880 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
881
882 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
883 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
884 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
885
886 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
887 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
888 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
889 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
890
891 @end enumerate
892
893 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
894 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
895 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
896
897 @section Project Directory
898
899 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
900
901 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
902 single directory for your work with a given board.
903 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
904 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
905 files accessed through semihosting,
906 and for code you upload to the target board.
907 It is also the natural place to write files,
908 such as log files and data you download from the board.
909
910 @section Configuration Basics
911
912 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
913 a variety of ways you can mix them.
914 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
915
916 @itemize
917 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
918 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
919 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
920 @end itemize
921
922 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
923 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
924 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
925
926 @example
927 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
928
929 # GDB can also flash my flash!
930 gdb_memory_map enable
931 gdb_flash_program enable
932
933 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
934 @end example
935
936 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
937
938 @example
939 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
940 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
941 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
942 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
943 @end example
944
945 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
946 each supporting a different development task.
947 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
948 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
949
950 @quotation Important
951 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
952 problems with how it treats variables.
953 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
954 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
955 that can be tested in a later script.
956 @end quotation
957
958 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
959 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
960 to simplify your work.
961
962 @section User Config Files
963 @cindex config file, user
964 @cindex user config file
965 @cindex config file, overview
966
967 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
968 in one place.
969 One of the following will match your situation best:
970
971 @itemize
972 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
973 provided by someone else.
974 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
975 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
976 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
977 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
978 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
979 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
980
981 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
982 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
983
984 @enumerate
985 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
986 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
987 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
988 @end enumerate
989
990 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
991 The first is an interface config file.
992 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
993 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
994 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
995 meet your deadline:
996
997 @example
998 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
999 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1000 @end example
1001
1002 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1003 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1004 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1005 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1006
1007 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1008 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1009 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1010 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1011 target and board
1012 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1013 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1014
1015 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1016 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1017 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1018 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1019
1020 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1021 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1022 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1023 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1024 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1025
1026 @quotation Note
1027 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1028 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1029 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1030 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1031 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1032 @end quotation
1033
1034 @item
1035 You may need to write some C code.
1036 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1037 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1038 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1039 a new chip architecture.
1040 @end itemize
1041
1042 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1043 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1044 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1045
1046 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1047 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1048 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1049 @itemize
1050
1051 @item
1052 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1053 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1054 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1055 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1056
1057 @item
1058 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1059 @cindex vector_catch
1060 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1061 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1062 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1063 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1064 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1065 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1066
1067 @item
1068 You might need to override some defaults.
1069 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1070 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1071
1072 @item
1073 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1074 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1075 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1076 @end itemize
1077
1078 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1079
1080 A few project-specific utility
1081 routines may well speed up your work.
1082 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1083
1084 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1085 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1086 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1087 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1088 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1089 may help:
1090
1091 @example
1092 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1093 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1094 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1095 # Leave the CPU halted.
1096 reset init
1097
1098 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1099 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1100
1101 # Start running.
1102 resume 0x20000000
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1107 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1108 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1109 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1110 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1111
1112 @example
1113 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1114 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1115 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1116 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1117 reset init
1118
1119 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1120 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1121 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1122 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1123 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1124 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1125 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1126
1127 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1128 reset run
1129 @}
1130 @end example
1131
1132 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1133 from NAND.
1134 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1135 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1136 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1137
1138 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1139 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1140
1141 @section Target Software Changes
1142
1143 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1144 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1145 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1146 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1147 handling issues like:
1148
1149 @itemize @bullet
1150
1151 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1152 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1153 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1154 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1155 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1156 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1157 your debug sessions.
1158
1159 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1160 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1161 That might however be your only option.
1162
1163 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1164 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1165 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1166 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1167 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1168 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1169 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1170 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1171 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1172 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1173 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1174 instead of the whole thing.
1175 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1176 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1177
1178 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1179 @cindex ARM semihosting
1180 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1181 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1182 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1183 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1184 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1185 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1186 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1187 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1188 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1189 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1190 NAND or SPI flash.
1191
1192 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1193 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1194 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1195 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1196 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1197
1198 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1199 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1200 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1201 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1202 registers which can be used to change various features including
1203 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1204 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1205 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1206 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1207 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1208
1209 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1210 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1211 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1212 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1213 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1214
1215 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1216 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1217 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1218 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1219 early code execution can be debugged
1220 or firmware can be replaced.
1221
1222 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1223 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1224 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1225 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1226 operations like writing to memory.)
1227
1228 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1229 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1230 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1231 various kinds of message.
1232 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1233
1234 @end itemize
1235
1236 @section Target Hardware Setup
1237
1238 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1239 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1240 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1241 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1242 working with.}
1243
1244 Common issues include:
1245
1246 @itemize @bullet
1247
1248 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1249 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1250 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1251 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1252 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1253 or one from a daughtercard).
1254 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1255 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1256
1257 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1258 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1259 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1260 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1261 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1262 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1263
1264 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1265 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1266 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1267 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1268 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1269
1270
1271 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1272 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1273 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1274 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1275 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1276 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1277 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1278
1279 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1280 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1281 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1282 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1283 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1284
1285 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1286 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1287 used to start booting.
1288
1289 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1290 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1291 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1292 multiple audio codec chips).
1293 This interacts with software
1294 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1295 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1296 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1297 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1298 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1299 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1300 audio or video codecs are used.
1301
1302 @end itemize
1303
1304 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1305 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1306 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1307 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1308 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1309 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1310 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1311 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1312 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1313 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1314
1315
1316 @node Config File Guidelines
1317 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1318
1319 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1320 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1321 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1322 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1323
1324 You should find the following directories under
1325 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1326 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1327 @itemize @bullet
1328 @item @file{interface} ...
1329 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1330 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1331 @item @file{board} ...
1332 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1333 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1334
1335 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1336 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1337 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1338 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1339 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1340 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1341 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1342 a CPU and an FPGA.
1343 @item @file{target} ...
1344 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1345 on a chip
1346 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1347 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1348 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1349 the target config file defines all of them.
1350 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1351 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1352 @end itemize
1353
1354 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1355 file may override features in any of the above files by
1356 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1357 commands specific to their situation.
1358
1359 @section Interface Config Files
1360
1361 The user config file
1362 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1363
1364 @example
1365 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1366 @end example
1367
1368 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1369 in use today with OpenOCD.
1370 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1371 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1372
1373 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1374 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1375 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1376 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1377 and need to provide a driver for it.
1378
1379 @section Board Config Files
1380 @cindex config file, board
1381 @cindex board config file
1382
1383 The user config file
1384 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1385
1386 @example
1387 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1388 @end example
1389
1390 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1391 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1392 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1393
1394 @enumerate
1395 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1396 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1397 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1398 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1399 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1400 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1401 @end enumerate
1402
1403 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1404 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1405 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1406 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1407
1408 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1409 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1410 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1411 configuration works.
1412
1413 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1414
1415 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1416 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1417 convention on how to use certain variables.
1418
1419 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1420 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1421 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1422 used at will within a target configuration file.
1423
1424 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1425 for a board with three chips:
1426
1427 @example
1428 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1429 set CHIPNAME network
1430 set ENDIAN big
1431 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1432 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1433 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1434 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1435
1436 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1437 set CHIPNAME video
1438 set ENDIAN little
1439 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1440 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1441 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1442 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1443
1444 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1445 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1446 unset ENDIAN
1447 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1448 @end example
1449
1450 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1451 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1452 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1453 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1454 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1455 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1456 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1457 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1458
1459 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1460 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1461 naming collisions.
1462
1463 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1464 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1465 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1466 up other clocks and peripherals.
1467
1468 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1469 @cindex variable names
1470
1471 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1472 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1473 one such chip (as shown above).
1474 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1475 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1476 to promote consistency and
1477 so that board files can override target defaults.
1478
1479 Inputs to target config files include:
1480
1481 @itemize @bullet
1482 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1483 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1484 tap identifier dotted names.
1485 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1486 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1487 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1488 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1489 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1490 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1491 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1492 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1493 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1494 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1495 @end itemize
1496
1497 Outputs from target config files include:
1498
1499 @itemize @bullet
1500 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1501 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1502 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1503 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1504 specific to that board and that target.
1505 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1506 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1507 @end itemize
1508
1509 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1510 @cindex event, reset-init
1511 @cindex reset-init handler
1512
1513 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1514 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1515 fully set up yet.
1516 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1517 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1518 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1519 handler is one of the most important.
1520
1521 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1522 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1523 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1524 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1525 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1526
1527 @quotation Note
1528 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1529 are included here.
1530 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1531 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1532 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1533 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1534 @end quotation
1535
1536 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1537 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1538 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1539 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1540 those as parameters.
1541 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1542 and disabling the watchdog.
1543 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1544 the next developer doing such work.
1545 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1546
1547 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1548 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1549 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1550 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1551
1552 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1553
1554 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1555 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1556 a low JTAG clock rate.
1557 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1558 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1559 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1560 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1561 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1562 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1563 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1564
1565 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1566 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1567 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1568 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1569 which might be less than that.
1570
1571 @quotation Warning
1572 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1573 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1574 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1575 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1576 @end quotation
1577
1578 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1579 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1580 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1581 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1582 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1583 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1584
1585 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1586 @subsection The init_board procedure
1587 @cindex init_board procedure
1588
1589 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1590 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1591 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1592 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1593 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1594 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1595 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1596 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1597 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1598 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1599 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1600 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1601
1602 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1603 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1604
1605 @example
1606 ### board_file.cfg ###
1607
1608 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1609 source [find target/target.cfg]
1610
1611 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1612 # enables fast on-board clock source
1613 # configures the chip to use it
1614 @}
1615
1616 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1617 proc init_board @{@} @{
1618 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1619
1620 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1621 adapter speed 100
1622 @}
1623
1624 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1625 enable_fast_clock
1626 adapter speed 10000
1627 @}
1628 @}
1629 @end example
1630
1631 @section Target Config Files
1632 @cindex config file, target
1633 @cindex target config file
1634
1635 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1636 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1637 more target config files like this:
1638
1639 @example
1640 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1641 @end example
1642
1643 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1644 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1645 In summary the target files should contain
1646
1647 @enumerate
1648 @item Set defaults
1649 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1650 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1651 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1652 @item On-Chip flash
1653 @end enumerate
1654
1655 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1656 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1657 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1658
1659 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1660 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1661 can talk to the chip.
1662 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1663 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1664 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1665 and other processing engines.
1666
1667 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1668
1669 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1670 letting board config files express environment-specific
1671 differences in how things should be set up.
1672
1673 @example
1674 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1675 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1676 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1677 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1680 @}
1681
1682 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1683 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1684 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1685 @} else @{
1686 set _ENDIAN little
1687 @}
1688
1689 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1690 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1691 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1692 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1693 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1694 @} else @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1696 @}
1697 @end example
1698 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1699
1700 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1701 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1702 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1703
1704 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1705 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1706 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1707
1708 @example
1709 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1710 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1711 @end example
1712
1713 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1714 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1715 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1716 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1717 for taps.
1718
1719 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1720 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1721 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1722 looks (in part) like this:
1723
1724 @example
1725 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1726 @end example
1727
1728 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1729 to source such a config file twice, with different
1730 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1731 it adds a different TAP each time.
1732
1733 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1734 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1735 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1736 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1737
1738 @example
1739 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1740 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1741 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1743 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1744 @end example
1745
1746 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1747 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1748
1749 @itemize
1750 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1751 plus a JRC to enable them
1752 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1753 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1754 is not currently used)
1755 @end itemize
1756
1757 @subsection Add CPU targets
1758
1759 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1760 GDB and other commands can use it.
1761 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1762 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1763 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1764 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1765
1766 @example
1767 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1768 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1769 @end example
1770
1771 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1772 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1773 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1774 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1775 a work area if you can.
1776 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1777
1778 @example
1779 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1780 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1781 @end example
1782
1783 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1784 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1785 @cindex SMP
1786 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1787
1788 @example
1789 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1791 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1792 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1795 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1796 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1797 @end example
1798 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1799 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1800 @itemize @bullet
1801 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1802 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1803 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1804 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1805 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1806 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1807 @end itemize
1808
1809 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1810 command have been implemented.
1811 @itemize @bullet
1812 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1813 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1814 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1815 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1816 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1817 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1818 following example.
1819 @end itemize
1820
1821 @example
1822 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1823 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1824 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1825 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1826 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1827 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1828 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1829 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1830 > resume
1831 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1832 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1833 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1836 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1837 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1838 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1839 @end example
1840
1841
1842 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1843
1844 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1845 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1846 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1847
1848 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1849 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1850 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1851 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1852 both signals.
1853
1854 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1855 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1856 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1857 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1858 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1859 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1860 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1861 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1862 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1863 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1864 not available.)
1865
1866 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1867 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1868 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1869 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1870 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1871 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1872 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1873 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1874
1875 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1876 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1877 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1878 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1879 slower clock than they will use later.
1880 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1881 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1882 than they will use later.
1883 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1884
1885 @quotation Important
1886 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1887 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1888 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1889 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1890 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1891 @end quotation
1892
1893 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1894 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1895 @cindex init_targets procedure
1896
1897 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1898 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1899 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1900 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1901 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1902 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1903 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1904 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1905 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1906
1907 @example
1908 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1909
1910 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1911 # basic initialization procedure ...
1912 @}
1913
1914 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1915 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1916 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1917 @}
1918
1919 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1920
1921 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1922
1923 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1924 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1925 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1926 @}
1927 @end example
1928
1929 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1930 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1931
1932 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1933
1934 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1935 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1936
1937 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1938 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1939 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1940
1941 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1942 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1943 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1944 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1945 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1946 events already assigned.
1947
1948 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1949
1950 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1951 special high speed download features - enable it.
1952
1953 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1954
1955 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1956 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1957 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1958 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1959 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1960 If you are using an external trace port,
1961 configure it in your board config file.
1962 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1963 configure it in your target config file.
1964
1965 @example
1966 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1967 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1968 @end example
1969
1970 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1971
1972 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1973
1974 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1975 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1976 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1977 the TARGET (chip) file.
1978
1979 Examples:
1980 @itemize @bullet
1981 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1982 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1983 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1984 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1985 @end itemize
1986
1987 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1988 @section Translating Configuration Files
1989 @cindex translation
1990 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1991 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1992 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1993 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1994 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1995 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1996
1997 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1998 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1999 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2000 convert other scripts later on.
2001
2002 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2003 replace job:
2004
2005 @example
2006 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2007 #
2008 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2009 #
2010 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2011 #
2012 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2013
2014 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2015 global TARGETNAME
2016
2017 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2018
2019 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2020 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2021 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2022 @}
2023 @end example
2024
2025
2026
2027 @node Server Configuration
2028 @chapter Server Configuration
2029 @cindex initialization
2030 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2031 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2032 supported.
2033
2034 @anchor{configurationstage}
2035 @section Configuration Stage
2036 @cindex configuration stage
2037 @cindex config command
2038
2039 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2040 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2041 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2042 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2043 inside startup scripts.
2044
2045 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2046 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2047 which may be issued interactively.
2048 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2049 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2050
2051 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2052 flash banks,
2053 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2054 and other basic setup.
2055 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2056 may access or activate TAPs.
2057 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2058 longer be issued.
2059
2060 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2061 @section Entering the Run Stage
2062
2063 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2064 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2065 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2066 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2067 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2068 You should see no errors at this point.
2069 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2070 commands you used to configure the server.
2071 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2072 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2073 on the scan chain.
2074
2075 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2076 become available.
2077 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2078 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2079 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2080 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2081 entry to the run stage.
2082
2083 @deffn {Config Command} init
2084 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2085 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2086 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2087 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2088 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2089 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2090
2091 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2092 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2093 configuration files and/or command line options.
2094
2095 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2096 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2097 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2098 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2099 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2100 @end deffn
2101
2102 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2103 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2104 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2105
2106 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2107 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2108 scan chain.
2109 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2110 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2111
2112 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2113 they return.
2114 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2115 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2116 @end deffn
2117
2118 @anchor{tcpipports}
2119 @section TCP/IP Ports
2120 @cindex TCP port
2121 @cindex server
2122 @cindex port
2123 @cindex security
2124 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2125 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2126 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2127
2128 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2129 access using one or more of these ports.
2130 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2131 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2132 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2133
2134 @anchor{gdb_port}
2135 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2136 @cindex GDB server
2137 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2138 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2139 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2140 the normal use cases.
2141
2142 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2143 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2144 disables the gdb server.
2145
2146 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2147 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2148
2149 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2150 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2151
2152 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2153 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2154 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2155
2156 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2157 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2158 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2159 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2160 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2161 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2162 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2163 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2164 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2165
2166 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2167 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2168 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2169 @end deffn
2170
2171 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2172 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2173 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2174 output from the Tcl engine.
2175 Intended as a machine interface.
2176 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2177 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2178 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2179 @end deffn
2180
2181 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2182 Specify or query the
2183 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2184 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2185 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2186 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2187 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2188 @end deffn
2189
2190 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2191 @section GDB Configuration
2192 @cindex GDB
2193 @cindex GDB configuration
2194 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2195 The ones listed here are static and global.
2196 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2197 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2198
2199 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2200 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2201 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2202 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2203 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2204 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2205 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2209 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2210 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2211 vFlash packet is received.
2212 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2213 @end deffn
2214
2215 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2216 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2217 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2218 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2219 for flash programming to work.
2220 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2226 by GDB memory read packets.
2227 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2228 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2232 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2233 packets report errors or not.
2234 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2235 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2236 @end deffn
2237
2238 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2239 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2240 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2241 @end deffn
2242
2243 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2244 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2245
2246 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2247 @end deffn
2248
2249 @anchor{eventpolling}
2250 @section Event Polling
2251
2252 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2253 where significant events can happen at any time.
2254 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2255 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2256 or to GDB.
2257
2258 Examples of such events include:
2259
2260 @itemize
2261 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2262 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2263 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2264 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2265 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2266 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2267 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2268 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2269 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2270 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2271 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2272 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2273 @end itemize
2274
2275 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2276 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2277 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2278 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2279 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2280
2281 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2282 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2283 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2284 to the various active targets.
2285 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2286 which is normally done in the background.
2287
2288 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2289 Poll the current target for its current state.
2290 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2291 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2292 specific information about the current state is printed.
2293 An optional parameter
2294 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2295
2296 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2297 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2298 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2299 @example
2300 > poll
2301 background polling: on
2302 target state: halted
2303 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2304 current mode: Supervisor
2305 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2306 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2307 >
2308 @end example
2309 @end deffn
2310
2311 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2312 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2313 @cindex config file, interface
2314 @cindex interface config file
2315
2316 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2317 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2318 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2319
2320 @quotation Note
2321 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2322 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2323 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2324 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2325 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2326 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2327 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2328 @end quotation
2329
2330 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2331 through commands in an interface configuration
2332 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2333 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2334
2335 @example
2336 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2337 @end example
2338
2339 These commands tell
2340 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2341 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2342
2343 @example
2344 # jlink interface
2345 adapter driver jlink
2346 @end example
2347
2348 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2349
2350
2351 @section Adapter Configuration
2352
2353 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2354 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2355 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2356
2357 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2358 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2359 target.
2360 @end deffn
2361
2362 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2363 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2364 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2365 @end deffn
2366 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2367 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2368 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2369 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2370 the hardware can support.
2371 @end deffn
2372
2373
2374
2375 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2376 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2380 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2381 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2382 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2383 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2384 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2385 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2386
2387 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2388 @end deffn
2389
2390 @section Interface Drivers
2391
2392 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2393 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2394 available at run time.
2395
2396 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2397 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2398 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2399 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2400
2401 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2402 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2403 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2407 Displays status of RTCK option.
2408 Optionally sets that option first.
2409 @end deffn
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2413 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2414 This has one driver-specific command:
2415
2416 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2417 Logs some status
2418 @end deffn
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2422 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2423 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2424 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2425 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2426 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2430 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2431
2432 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2433 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2434 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2435 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2436 @example
2437 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2438 @end example
2439 @end deffn
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2442 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2443 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2444 @end deffn
2445
2446 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2447 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2448 @end deffn
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2452 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2453 @end deffn
2454
2455 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2456 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2460 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2461 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2462
2463 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2464 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2465
2466 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2467 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2468
2469 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2470 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2471 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2472 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2473 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2474 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2475
2476 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2477 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2478 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2479 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2480 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2481
2482 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2483 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2484 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2485 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2486
2487 @itemize @minus
2488 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2489 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2491 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2493 switching data and direction as necessary
2494 @end itemize
2495
2496 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2497 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2498
2499 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2500 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2501 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2502 @example
2503 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2504 @end example
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2508 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2509 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2510 during device selection.
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2514 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2515 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2516 is connected to the host.
2517 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2518 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2519 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2520 @end deffn
2521
2522 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2523 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2524 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2525
2526 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2527 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2528 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2529 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2530 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2531
2532 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2533 @end deffn
2534
2535 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2536 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2537 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2541 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2542 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2543 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2544 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2545 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2546 and initially asserted reset signals.
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2550 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2551 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2552 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2553 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2554 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2555 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2556 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2557 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2558 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2559 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2560
2561 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2562 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2563 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2564 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2565 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2566 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2567
2568 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2569 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2570 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2571 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2572 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2573 are always driven by the FTDI.
2574
2575 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2576 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2577 @var{name}.
2578 @end deffn
2579
2580 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2581 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2582 @itemize @minus
2583 @item @option{0}, drive low
2584 @item @option{1}, drive high
2585 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2586 @end itemize
2587 @end deffn
2588
2589 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2590 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2591 @end deffn
2592
2593 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2594 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2595
2596 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2597 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2598 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2599 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2600 @itemize @minus
2601 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2602 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2603 @end itemize
2604 @end deffn
2605
2606 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2607 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2608
2609 @end deffn
2610
2611 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2612 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2613 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2614 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2615
2616 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2617 @itemize @minus
2618 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2619 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2620 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2621 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2622 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2623 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2624 @end itemize
2625
2626 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2627 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2628 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2629 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2630 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2631 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2632 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2633 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2634
2635 FT232R
2636 @itemize @minus
2637 @item bit 7 - RI
2638 @item bit 6 - DCD
2639 @item bit 5 - DSR
2640 @item bit 4 - DTR
2641 @item bit 3 - CTS
2642 @item bit 2 - RTS
2643 @item bit 1 - RXD
2644 @item bit 0 - TXD
2645 @end itemize
2646
2647 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2648 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2649
2650 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2651 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2652 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2656 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2657 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2658 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2662 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2663 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2667 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2668 @end deffn
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2671 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2675 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2679 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2683 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2687 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2691 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2692 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2693 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2694 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2695 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2696 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2697 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2698 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2699 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2705 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2706 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2707 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2708
2709 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2710 processors which are being simulated.
2711
2712 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2713 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2714 sockets instead of TCP.
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2718 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2719 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2720 @end deffn
2721
2722 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2723 something like:
2724
2725 @example
2726 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2727 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2728 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2729 @end example
2730
2731 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2732 named mysocket:
2733
2734 @example
2735 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2736 remote_bitbang_port 0
2737 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2738 @end example
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2742 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2743 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2744 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2747 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2748 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2749 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2750 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2754 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2755 default values are used.
2756 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2757 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2758 @example
2759 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2760 @end example
2761 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2762 @example
2763 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2764 @end example
2765 @end deffn
2766
2767 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2768 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2769 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2770 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2771 target board.
2772
2773 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2774 @example
2775 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2776 reset_config srst_only
2777 @end example
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2781 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2782 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2783 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2787 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2788 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2794 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2795 This has one driver-specific command:
2796
2797 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2798 Display either the address of the I/O port
2799 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2800 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2801 This is a write-once setting.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @end deffn
2804
2805 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2806 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2807 transports.
2808
2809 @quotation Compatibility Note
2810 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2811 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2812 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2813 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2814 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2815 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2816 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2817 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2818 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2819 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2820 @end quotation
2821
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2823 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2824 states.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2827 Display free device internal memory.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2830 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2831 command version.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2834 Display the device configuration.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2837 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2838 power state.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2841 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2844 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2845 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2846 IP configuration.
2847 @end deffn
2848 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2849 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2850 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2851 @end deffn
2852 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2853 Reset the current configuration.
2854 @end deffn
2855 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2856 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2859 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2860 pairs.
2861
2862 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2863 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2864 @example
2865 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2866 @end example
2867 @end deffn
2868 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2869 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2870 pairs.
2871
2872 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2873 @example
2874 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2875 77a90000
2876 @end example
2877 @end deffn
2878 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2879 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2880 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2881 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2882 instead.
2883
2884 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2885 @end deffn
2886 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2887 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2888 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2889
2890 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2891 @end deffn
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2895 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2896 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2897 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2898 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2899 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2900 configuration script.
2901
2902 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2903 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2904 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2905 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2906 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2907
2908 Known limitations:
2909 @itemize @bullet
2910 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2911 and 2.7 MHz.
2912 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2913 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2914 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2915 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2916 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2917 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2918 communications with the target.
2919 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2920 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2921 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2922 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2923 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2924 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2925 @end itemize
2926
2927 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2928 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2929 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2933 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2934 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2938 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2939 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2940 target as a side-effect.
2941 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2942 @end deffn
2943
2944 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2945 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2946 version, and target voltage.
2947 @end deffn
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2951 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2952 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2953 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2954 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2957 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2958 This is a write-once setting.
2959 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2960
2961 @itemize @minus
2962 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2963 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2964 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2965 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2966 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2967 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2968 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2969 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2970 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2971 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2972 some versions of
2973 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2974 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2975 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2976 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2977 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2978 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2979 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2980 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2981 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2982 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2983 @end itemize
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2987 Display either the address of the I/O port
2988 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2989 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2990 This is a write-once setting.
2991
2992 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2993 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2994 you may encounter a problem.
2995 @end deffn
2996
2997 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2998 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2999 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3000 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3001 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3002 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3003
3004 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3005 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3006 @quotation Tip
3007 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3008 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3009 @example
3010 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3011 > adapter speed 500
3012 @end example
3013 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3014 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3015 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3016 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3017 large set of samples.
3018 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3019 @example
3020 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3021 @end example
3022 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3023 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3024
3025 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3026 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3027 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3028 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3029 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3030 be conservative.
3031 @end quotation
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3035 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3036 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3037 @end deffn
3038
3039 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3040 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3041
3042 @example
3043 adapter driver parport
3044 parport_port 0x278
3045 parport_cable wiggler
3046 @end example
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3050 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3051 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3052 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3053 @end deffn
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3057 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3061 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3065 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3066
3067 @quotation Note
3068 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3069 which are not currently documented here.
3070 @end quotation
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @anchor{hla_interface}
3074 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3075 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3076 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3077 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3078
3079 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3080 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3081 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3082 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3083 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3084 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3085
3086 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3087 Currently Not Supported.
3088 @end deffn
3089
3090 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3091 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3095 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3096 @end deffn
3097
3098 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3099 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3103 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3104 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3105 @end deffn
3106 @end deffn
3107
3108 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3109 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3110 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3111 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3112 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3113
3114 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3115 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3116 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3117 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3118
3119 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3120 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3121
3122 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3123 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3127 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3128 @end deffn
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3132 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3136 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3137 @end deffn
3138
3139 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3140 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3141 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3142 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3143 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3144
3145 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3146 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3147 XDS110 found will be used.
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3151 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3152 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3153 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3154 @end deffn
3155
3156 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3157 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3158 version).
3159 @end deffn
3160 @end deffn
3161
3162 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3163 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3164 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3165 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3166 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3167
3168 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3169
3170 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3171 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3172
3173 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3174 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3175
3176 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3177
3178 @end deffn
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3182 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3183 @end deffn
3184
3185 @quotation Note
3186 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3187 which are not currently documented here.
3188 @end quotation
3189
3190 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3191 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3192 No arguments: print status.
3193 @end deffn
3194
3195 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3196 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3197 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3198
3199 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3200 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3201 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3202 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3203 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3204 configuration on exit.
3205
3206 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3207 pinout.
3208
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3212 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3213 of the one which is most popular.
3214
3215 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3216
3217 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3218 pinout.
3219
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222
3223 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3224 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3225 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3226
3227 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3228 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3229 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3230
3231 @itemize @minus
3232 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3233 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3234 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3235 @end itemize
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3239 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3240 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3241 @end deffn
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244
3245 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3246 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3247 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3248 DPI server interface.
3249
3250 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3251 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3255 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3256 @end deffn
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259
3260 @section Transport Configuration
3261 @cindex Transport
3262 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3263 and the debug adapter you are using,
3264 several transports may be available to
3265 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3266 @deffn Command {transport list}
3267 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3268 version of OpenOCD.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3272 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3273
3274 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3275 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3276 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3277 adapter's driver).
3278
3279 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3280 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3281 supported by the debug adapter.
3282
3283 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3284 transport, if any.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @subsection JTAG Transport
3288 @cindex JTAG
3289 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3290 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3291 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3292 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3293 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3294 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3295
3296 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3297 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3298 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3299 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3300 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3301
3302 @subsection SWD Transport
3303 @cindex SWD
3304 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3305 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3306 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3307 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3308 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3309 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3310 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3311
3312 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3313 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3314 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3315 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3316 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3317
3318 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3319 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3320 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3321 expected to change.
3322 @end deffn
3323 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3324 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3325 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3326 No parameters: displays current settings.
3327 @end deffn
3328
3329 @subsection SPI Transport
3330 @cindex SPI
3331 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3332 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3333 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3334 solution for flash programming.
3335
3336 @anchor{swimtransport}
3337 @subsection SWIM Transport
3338 @cindex SWIM
3339 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3340 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3341 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3342 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3343
3344 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3345
3346 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3347
3348 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3349 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3350 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3351 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3352 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3353
3354 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3355 @section JTAG Speed
3356 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3357 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3358 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3359 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3360 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3361 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3362 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3363 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3364 power management software that may be active.
3365
3366 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3367 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3368 target event handler.
3369 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3370 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3371 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3372 sets up those clocks).
3373 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3374 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3375 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3376 in the target config file.
3377 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3378 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3379 config file instead.
3380 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3381 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3382 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3383
3384 @example
3385 jtag_rclk 3000
3386 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3387 @end example
3388
3389 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3390 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3391 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3392 may not be the fastest solution.
3393
3394 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3395 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3396 which support adaptive clocking.
3397
3398 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3399 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3400 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3401 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3402 than the speed specified.
3403
3404 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3405 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3406 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3407 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3408
3409 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3410 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3411 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3412 JTAG clocking after setup.
3413 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3414 If the interface device can not
3415 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3416 @end deffn
3417
3418 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3419 @cindex adaptive clocking
3420 @cindex RTCK
3421 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3422 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3423 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3424 @example
3425 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3426 jtag_rclk 3000
3427 @end example
3428 @end defun
3429
3430 @node Reset Configuration
3431 @chapter Reset Configuration
3432 @cindex Reset Configuration
3433
3434 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3435 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3436 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3437 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3438 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3439 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3440 Please see the various board files for examples.
3441
3442 @quotation Note
3443 To maintainers and integrators:
3444 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3445 Normally the board configuration file
3446 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3447 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3448
3449 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3450 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3451 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3452 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3453 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3454 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3455 @end quotation
3456
3457 @section Types of Reset
3458
3459 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3460 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3461 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3462
3463 @itemize @bullet
3464 @item
3465 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3466 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3467 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3468 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3469 @item
3470 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3471 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3472 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3473 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3474 @item
3475 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3476 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3477 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3478 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3479 @item
3480 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3481 several other types of reset.
3482 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3483 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3484 There may be individual module resets.
3485 @end itemize
3486
3487 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3488 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3489 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3490 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3491 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3492 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3493 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3494 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3495 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3496
3497 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3498 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3499
3500 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3501 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3502 common issues are:
3503
3504 @itemize @bullet
3505
3506 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3507 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3508 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3509 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3510 when either of those signals is not connected.
3511 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3512 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3513 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3514 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3515
3516 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3517 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3518 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3519 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3520
3521 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3522 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3523 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3524 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3525 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3526 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3527 hardware debouncing.
3528 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3529 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3530
3531 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3532 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3533 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3534 to use push/pull output drivers.
3535 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3536 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3537 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3538 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3539
3540 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3541 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3542 issues (not limited to errata).
3543 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3544 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3545 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3546 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3547 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3548 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3549 @end itemize
3550
3551 There can also be other issues.
3552 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3553 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3554 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3555 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3556 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3557 Agreement (NDA).
3558
3559 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3560 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3561 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3562
3563 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3564 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3565
3566 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3567
3568 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3569 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3570 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3571 allowing it to be deasserted.
3572 @end deffn
3573
3574 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3575 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3576 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3577 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3578 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3579 @end deffn
3580
3581 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3582 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3583 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3584 allowing it to be deasserted.
3585 @end deffn
3586
3587 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3588 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3589 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3590 @end deffn
3591
3592 @anchor{reset_config}
3593 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3594 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3595 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3596 configuration scripts.
3597
3598 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3599 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3600 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3601 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3602 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3603 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3604 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3605 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3606
3607 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3608 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3609 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3610 -- may be specified at a time.
3611 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3612 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3613 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3614 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3615 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3616
3617 @itemize
3618 @item
3619 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3620 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3621 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3622 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3623 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3624
3625 @quotation Tip
3626 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3627 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3628 @end quotation
3629
3630 @item
3631 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3632 signal implementations.
3633 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3634 indicating everything behaves normally.
3635 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3636 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3637 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3638 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3639 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3640 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3641 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3642
3643 @item
3644 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3645 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3646 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3647 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3648 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3649 while SRST is asserted.
3650 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3651 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3652
3653 @item
3654 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3655 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3656 is required to use this option.
3657 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3658 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3659 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3660 be asserted before any target connection.
3661 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3662 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3663 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3664 @end itemize
3665
3666 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3667 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3668 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3669 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3670 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3671
3672 @itemize
3673 @item
3674 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3675 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3676 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3677 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3678
3679 @item
3680 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3681 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3682 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3683 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3684 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3685 @end itemize
3686 @end deffn
3687
3688 @section Custom Reset Handling
3689 @cindex events
3690
3691 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3692 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3693 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3694 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3695 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3696 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3697
3698 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3699 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3700 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3701 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3702 want to reset everything at once.
3703
3704 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3705 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3706 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3707 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3708 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3709 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3710 needs special attention.
3711
3712 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3713 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3714 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3715 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3716 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3717 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3718 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3719 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3720 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3721
3722 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3723 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3724 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3725 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3726 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3727
3728 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3729 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3730 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3731 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3732 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3733 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3734 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3735 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3736 or potentially some other value.
3737
3738 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3739 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3740 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3741 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3742 (or their associated targets)
3743 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3744
3745 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3746 they return.
3747 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3748 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3749 @end deffn
3750
3751 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3752 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3753 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3754 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3755 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3756 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3757 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3758 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3759 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3760 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3761 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3762 @end deffn
3763
3764 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3765 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3766 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3767 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3768 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771
3772 @node TAP Declaration
3773 @chapter TAP Declaration
3774 @cindex TAP declaration
3775 @cindex TAP configuration
3776
3777 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3778 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3779
3780 @itemize @bullet
3781 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3782 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3783 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3784 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3785 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3786 start running that code.
3787 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3788 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3789 and missing connections.
3790 @end itemize
3791
3792 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3793 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3794 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3795 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3796 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3797
3798 @section Scan Chains
3799 @cindex scan chain
3800
3801 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3802 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3803 They also need to be added to
3804 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3805 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3806 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3807 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3808 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3809 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3810 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3811 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3812
3813 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3814 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3815 command, presented in the next chapter.
3816 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3817 debugging targets.)
3818 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3819
3820 @verbatim
3821 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3822 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3823 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3824 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3825 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3826 @end verbatim
3827
3828 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3829 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3830 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3831 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3832 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3833 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3834 until they are told to do so.
3835
3836 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3837 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3838 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3839 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3840
3841 @example
3842 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3843 @end example
3844
3845 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3846 by a given chip.
3847 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3848 and so forth.
3849 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3850 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3851 both inside a single chip and between them.
3852 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3853
3854 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3855 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3856 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3857 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3858 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3859 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3860 includes commands something like this:
3861
3862 @example
3863 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3864 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3865 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3866 @end example
3867
3868 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3869 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3870 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3871
3872 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3873 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3874 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3875 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3876 @example
3877 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3878 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3879 @}
3880 @end example
3881 @end deffn
3882
3883 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3884 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3885 and their status.
3886 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3887 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3888 but systems with a JTAG router can
3889 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3890 @end deffn
3891
3892 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3893 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3894
3895 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3896 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3897
3898 @section TAP Names
3899 @cindex dotted name
3900
3901 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3902 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3903 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3904 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3905 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3906 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3907 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3908 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3909
3910 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3911 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3912 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3913
3914 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3915
3916 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3917 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3918 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3919 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3920
3921 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3922 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3923 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3924 overridable.
3925
3926 @cindex TAP naming convention
3927 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3928 and should follow this convention:
3929
3930 @itemize @bullet
3931 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3932 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3933 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3934 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3935 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3936 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3937 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3938 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3939 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3940 with a single TAP;
3941 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3942 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3943 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3944 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3945 @end itemize
3946
3947 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3948
3949 @itemize @bullet
3950 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3951 @*The length in bits of the
3952 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3953 @end itemize
3954
3955 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3956
3957 @itemize @bullet
3958 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3959 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3960 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3961 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3962 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3963 (the TAP is linked in).
3964 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3965 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3966 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3967 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3968 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3969 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3970 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3971 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3972 values that were found but not included in the list.
3973
3974 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3975 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3976 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3977 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3978 hardware to find these values.
3979 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3980 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3981 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3982 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3983 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3984 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3985 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3986 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3987 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3988 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3989 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3990 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3991 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3992 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3993 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3994 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3995 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3996 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3997 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3998 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3999 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4000 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4001 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4002 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4003 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4004 @end itemize
4005 @end deffn
4006
4007 @section Other TAP commands
4008
4009 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4010 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4014 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4015 At this writing this TAP attribute
4016 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4017 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4018 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4019 See the next section for information about the available events.
4020
4021 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4022 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4023 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4024 @end deffn
4025
4026 @section TAP Events
4027 @cindex events
4028 @cindex TAP events
4029
4030 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4031 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4032 The other applies to debugger targets,
4033 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4034
4035 The TAP events currently defined are:
4036
4037 @itemize @bullet
4038 @item @b{post-reset}
4039 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4040 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4041 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4042 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4043 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4044
4045 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4046 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4047 of any particular target.
4048 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4049 @item @b{setup}
4050 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4051 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4052 @item @b{tap-disable}
4053 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4054 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4055 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4056 @item @b{tap-enable}
4057 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4058 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4059 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4060 @end itemize
4061
4062 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4063 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4064 contents to be accurate), you might:
4065
4066 @example
4067 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4068 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4069 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4070 @}
4071 @end example
4072
4073
4074 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4075 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4076 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4077 @cindex jrc
4078
4079 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4080 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4081 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4082 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4083 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4084
4085 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4086 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4087 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4088 be visible.
4089 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4090 ignores, such as:
4091
4092 @itemize
4093 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4094 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4095 TAPs receive new instructions.
4096 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4097 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4098 @end itemize
4099
4100 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4101 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4102 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4103 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4104
4105 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4106 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4107
4108 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4109 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4110 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4111 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4112 should define TAP event handlers using
4113 code that looks something like this:
4114
4115 @example
4116 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4117 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4118 @}
4119 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4120 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4121 @}
4122 @end example
4123
4124 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4125
4126 @example
4127 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4128 @end example
4129
4130 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4131 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4132 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4133 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4134
4135 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4136 If necessary, disables the tap
4137 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4138 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4139 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4140 and "0" if it is disabled.
4141 @end deffn
4142
4143 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4144 If necessary, enables the tap
4145 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4146 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4147 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4148 and "0" if it is disabled.
4149 @end deffn
4150
4151 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4152 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4153 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4154 and "0" if it is disabled.
4155
4156 @quotation Note
4157 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4158 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4159 @end quotation
4160 @end deffn
4161
4162 @anchor{autoprobing}
4163 @section Autoprobing
4164 @cindex autoprobe
4165 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4166
4167 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4168 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4169 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4170 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4171
4172 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4173 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4174 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4175 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4176 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4177 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4178 right when they come out of reset).
4179
4180 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4181
4182 @example
4183 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4184 reset_config trst_and_srst
4185 jtag_rclk 8
4186 @end example
4187
4188 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4189 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4190
4191 @enumerate
4192 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4193 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4194 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4195 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4196 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4197 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4198 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4199 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4200 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4201 that is discovered.
4202 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4203 register, it will report it.
4204 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4205 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4206 @end enumerate
4207
4208 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4209 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4210 that's a bit more complex:
4211
4212 @example
4213 clock speed 8 kHz
4214 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4215 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4216 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4217 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4218 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4219 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4220 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4221 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4222 @end example
4223
4224 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4225 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4226 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4227 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4228 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4229 and so forth.
4230
4231 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4232 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4233 @cindex DAP declaration
4234
4235 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4236 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4237 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4238 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4239 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4240
4241 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4242
4243 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4244 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4245 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4246 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4247 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4248
4249 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4250
4251 @itemize @bullet
4252 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4253 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4254 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4255 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4256 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4257 @end itemize
4258 @end deffn
4259
4260 @deffn Command {dap names}
4261 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4262 for TCL scripting.
4263 @end deffn
4264
4265 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4266 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4267 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4268 @end deffn
4269
4270 @deffn Command {dap init}
4271 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4272 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4273 initialization, too.
4274 @end deffn
4275
4276 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4277
4278 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4279 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4280 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4281 @end deffn
4282
4283 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4284 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4285 @end deffn
4286
4287 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4288 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4289 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4290 or set a new value @var{value}.
4291 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4295 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4296 @end deffn
4297
4298 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4299 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4300 value @var{value}.
4301
4302 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4303 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4304 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4305
4306 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4307 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4308 @end deffn
4309
4310 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4311 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4312 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4313 @end deffn
4314
4315 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4316 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4317 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4318 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4322 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4323
4324 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4325 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4326 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4327 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4328 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4329 for details.
4330
4331 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4332 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4333 the pattern:
4334 @example
4335 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4336 @end example
4337
4338 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4339 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4340 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4341 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4342 @example
4343 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4344 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4345 @end example
4346
4347 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4348 @example
4349 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4350 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4351 @end example
4352
4353 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4354 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4355
4356 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4357 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4358 example with a proper dap name:
4359 @example
4360 xxx.dap apcsw default
4361 @end example
4362 @end deffn
4363
4364 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4365 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4366 Disabled by default
4367 @end deffn
4368
4369
4370 @node CPU Configuration
4371 @chapter CPU Configuration
4372 @cindex GDB target
4373
4374 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4375 You can also access these targets without GDB
4376 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4377 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4378 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4379 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4380
4381 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4382 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4383
4384 @section Target List
4385 @cindex target, current
4386 @cindex target, list
4387
4388 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4389 where each member has a name.
4390 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4391 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4392 (plural!) command.
4393 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4394 look like with more than one:
4395 @verbatim
4396 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4397 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4398 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4399 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4400 @end verbatim
4401
4402 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4403 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4404 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4405 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4406 space seen by that current target.
4407 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4408 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4409 are examples; and there are many more.
4410
4411 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4412
4413 @deffn Command {target current}
4414 Returns the name of the current target.
4415 @end deffn
4416
4417 @deffn Command {target names}
4418 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4419 @example
4420 foreach t [target names] @{
4421 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4422 @}
4423 @end example
4424 @end deffn
4425
4426 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4427 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4428
4429 @deffn Command targets [name]
4430 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4431 command names are singular.}
4432
4433 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4434 targets in a user friendly form.
4435
4436 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4437 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4438 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4439 @end deffn
4440
4441 @section Target CPU Types
4442 @cindex target type
4443 @cindex CPU type
4444
4445 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4446 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4447 when calling @command{target create}.
4448 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4449 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4450 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4451 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4452 what core-specific commands may be available
4453 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4454 and more.
4455
4456 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4457 since there's a command to list them.
4458
4459 @anchor{targettypes}
4460 @deffn Command {target types}
4461 Lists all supported target types.
4462 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4463
4464 @itemize @bullet
4465 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4466 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4467 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4468 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4469 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4470 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4471 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4472 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4473 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4474 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4475 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4476 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4477 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4478 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4479 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4480 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4481 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4482 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4483 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4484 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4485 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4486 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4487 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4488 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4489 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4490 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4491 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4492 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4493 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4494 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4495 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4496 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4497 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4498 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4499 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4500 @itemize @minus
4501 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4502 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4503 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4504 @end itemize
4505 And two debug interfaces cores:
4506 @itemize @minus
4507 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4508 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4509 @end itemize
4510 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4511 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4512 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4513 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4514 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4515 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4516 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4517 @end itemize
4518 @end deffn
4519
4520 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4521 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4522 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4523 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4524 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4525 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4526 reflect design generations;
4527 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4528 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4529
4530 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4531 @section Target Configuration
4532
4533 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4534 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4535 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4536 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4537 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4538
4539 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4540 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4541 optional parts.
4542 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4543 command, created as part of target creation.
4544
4545 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4546 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4547 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4548 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4549 to be much more board-specific.
4550 The key steps you use might look something like this
4551
4552 @example
4553 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4554 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4555 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4556 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4557 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4558 @end example
4559
4560 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4561 on-chip SRAM.
4562 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4563 writes to target memory;
4564 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4565 GDB memory checksumming;
4566 and more.
4567
4568 @quotation Warning
4569 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4570 inaccessible when application code
4571 (such as an operating system)
4572 enables or disables the MMU.
4573 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4574 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4575 easy access to other addresses needed.
4576 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4577 @end quotation
4578
4579 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4580 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4581 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4582 controllers.
4583 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4584 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4585 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4586
4587 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4588 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4589 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4590 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4591 purposes including additional configuration.
4592
4593 @itemize @bullet
4594 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4595 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4596 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4597 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4598
4599 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4600 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4601 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4602 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4603 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4604 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4605 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4606
4607 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4608 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4609 @end itemize
4610 @end deffn
4611
4612 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4613 The options accepted by this command may also be
4614 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4615 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4616 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4617
4618 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4619 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4620 and changing its endianness.
4621
4622 @itemize @bullet
4623
4624 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4625 used to access this target.
4626
4627 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4628 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4629 create and manage DAP instances.
4630
4631 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4632 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4633
4634 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4635 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4636 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4637 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4638 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4639 same event name assigns only one handler.
4640
4641 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4642 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4643
4644 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4645 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4646 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4647 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4648 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4649 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4650 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4651
4652 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4653 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4654 or virtual address is being used.
4655
4656 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4657 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4658
4659 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4660 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4661 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4662 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4663 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4664
4665 @anchor{rtostype}
4666 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4667 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4668 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4669 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4670 @option{RIOT}
4671 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4672
4673 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4674 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4675 access the target for debugging.
4676
4677 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4678 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4679 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4680 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4681
4682 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4683 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4684 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4685 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4686 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4687
4688 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4689 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4690 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4691 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4692 command @command{gdb_port}.
4693 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4694 @end itemize
4695 @end deffn
4696
4697 @section Other $target_name Commands
4698 @cindex object command
4699
4700 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4701 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4702
4703 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4704 Once a button is created a button
4705 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4706 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4707 configure it like this:
4708
4709 @example
4710 # Create
4711 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4712 # Modify
4713 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4714 # Query
4715 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4716 # Report
4717 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4718 @end example
4719
4720 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4721 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4722
4723 @example
4724 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4725 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4726 @end example
4727
4728 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4729
4730 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4731 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4732 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4733 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4734 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4735 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4736 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4737 They are not otherwise documented here.
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4741 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4742 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4743 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4744 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4745 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4746 the target side uses raw memory.
4747
4748 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4749 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4750 The script orientation comes from working with data
4751 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4752 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4753 and neither store nor return those values.
4754
4755 @itemize
4756 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4757 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4758 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4759 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4760 @end itemize
4761 @end deffn
4762
4763 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4764 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4765 @command{$target_name configure}
4766 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4767 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4768 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4769 There are a few special cases:
4770
4771 @itemize @bullet
4772 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4773 event named @var{event_name}.
4774 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4775 two parameters.
4776 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4777 This is a special case because this is set using
4778 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4779 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4780 @end itemize
4781
4782 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4783 all the targets you might use something like this:
4784
4785 @example
4786 foreach name [target names] @{
4787 set y [$name cget -endian]
4788 set z [$name cget -type]
4789 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4790 $x $name $y $z]
4791 @}
4792 @end example
4793 @end deffn
4794
4795 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4796 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4797 Displays the current target state:
4798 @code{debug-running},
4799 @code{halted},
4800 @code{reset},
4801 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4802 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4803 @end deffn
4804
4805 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4806 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4807 currently associated with this target.
4808 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4809 @end deffn
4810
4811 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4812 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4813 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4814 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4815 @end deffn
4816
4817 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4818 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4819 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4820 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4821 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4822 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4823 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4824 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4825 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4826 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4827 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4828 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4829 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4830 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4831 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4832 @end deffn
4833
4834 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4835 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4836 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4837 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4838 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4839 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4840 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4841 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4842 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4843 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4844 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4845 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4846 @end deffn
4847
4848 @anchor{targetevents}
4849 @section Target Events
4850 @cindex target events
4851 @cindex events
4852 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4853 For example:
4854 @itemize @bullet
4855 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4856 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4857 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4858 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4859 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4860 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4861 to set up system clocks or
4862 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4863 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4864 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4865 @end itemize
4866
4867 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4868 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4869 @command{target create ... -event}.
4870
4871 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4872 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4873 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4874
4875 @example
4876 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4877 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4878 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4879 @}
4880 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4881 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4882 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4883 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4884 @}
4885 @end example
4886
4887 The following target events are defined:
4888
4889 @itemize @bullet
4890 @item @b{debug-halted}
4891 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4892 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4893 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4894 @item @b{early-halted}
4895 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4896 @item @b{examine-start}
4897 @* Before target examine is called.
4898 @item @b{examine-end}
4899 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4900 @item @b{examine-fail}
4901 @* After target examine fails.
4902 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4903 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4904 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4905 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4906 connect GDB to running target.
4907 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4908 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4909 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4910 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4911 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4912 is in RAM or read only memory.
4913 Default is @code{halt}
4914 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4915 @* When GDB disconnects
4916 @item @b{gdb-end}
4917 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4918 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4919 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4920 @code{reset init})
4921 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4922 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4923 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4924 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4925 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4926 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4927 @item @b{gdb-start}
4928 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4929 @item @b{halted}
4930 @* The target has halted
4931 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4932 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4933 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4934 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4935 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4936 @item @b{reset-assert}
4937 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4938 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4939 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4940 it instead of asserting SRST.
4941 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4942 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4943 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4944 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4945 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4946 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4947 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4948 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4949 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4950 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4951 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4952 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4953 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4954 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4955 released on the scan chain.
4956 @item @b{reset-end}
4957 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4958 @item @b{reset-init}
4959 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4960 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4961
4962 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4963 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4964 multiplexing, and so on.
4965 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4966 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4967 @item @b{reset-start}
4968 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4969 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4970
4971 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4972 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4973 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4974 @item @b{resume-start}
4975 @* Before any target is resumed
4976 @item @b{resume-end}
4977 @* After all targets have resumed
4978 @item @b{resumed}
4979 @* Target has resumed
4980 @item @b{step-start}
4981 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4982 @item @b{step-end}
4983 @* After single-step has completed
4984 @item @b{trace-config}
4985 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4986 @end itemize
4987
4988 @node Flash Commands
4989 @chapter Flash Commands
4990
4991 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4992 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4993 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4994 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4995 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4996 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4997 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4998 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4999 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5000
5001 Flash Steps:
5002 @enumerate
5003 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5004 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5005 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5006 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5007 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5008 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5009 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5010 @item GDB Flashing
5011 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5012 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5013 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5014 @end enumerate
5015
5016 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5017 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5018 so that it can't boot.
5019 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5020 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5021
5022 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5023 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5024 @cindex flash configuration
5025
5026 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5027 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5028 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5029 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5030 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5031 see the driver-specific documentation.
5032
5033 @itemize @bullet
5034 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5035 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5036 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5037 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5038 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5039 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5040 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5041 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5042 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5043 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5044 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5045 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5046 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5047 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5048 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5049 commands to the flash controller.
5050 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5051 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5052 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5053 for more information.
5054 @end itemize
5055 @quotation Note
5056 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5057 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5058 @end quotation
5059 @end deffn
5060
5061 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5062 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5063 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5064 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5065 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5066 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5067 @end deffn
5068
5069 @deffn Command {flash list}
5070 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5071 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5072 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5073 @end deffn
5074
5075 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5076 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5077 depends on the flash type.
5078 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5079 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5080 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5081 but most don't bother.
5082 @end deffn
5083
5084 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5085
5086 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5087 begins.
5088
5089 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5090 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5091 until the programming session is finished.
5092
5093 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5094 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5095
5096 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5097
5098 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5099 @cindex flash erasing
5100 @cindex flash reading
5101 @cindex flash writing
5102 @cindex flash programming
5103 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5104
5105 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5106 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5107 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5108 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5109 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5110
5111 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5112 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5113 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5114 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5115 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5116
5117 @quotation Note
5118 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5119 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5120 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5121 back to a flash bank.
5122 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5123 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5124 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5125 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5126 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5127 @end quotation
5128
5129 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5130 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5131 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5132 disabled first.
5133 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5134 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5135 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5136
5137 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5138 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5139 up to and including @var{last}.
5140 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5141 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5142 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5144 @end deffn
5145
5146 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5147 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5148 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5149 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5150 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5151 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5152 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5153 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5154 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5155 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5156 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5157 before erase starts.
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5161 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5162 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5163 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5164 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5165 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5166 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5167 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5168 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5169 before issuing this command.
5170 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5171 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5172 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5173 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5174 @end deffn
5175 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5176
5177 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5178 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5179 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5180 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5181 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5182 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5183 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5184 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5185 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5186 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5187 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5188 @end deffn
5189
5190 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5191 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5192 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5193 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5194 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5195 @end deffn
5196
5197 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5198 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5199 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5200 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5201 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5202 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5206 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5207 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5208 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5210 @end deffn
5211
5212 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5213 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5214 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5215 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5216 to the base address for each section in the image.
5217 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5218 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5219 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5220 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5221 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5222 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5223 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5224 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5225 each image section.
5226
5227 @quotation Warning
5228 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5229 data you want to preserve.
5230 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5231 sections might be erased with no notice.
5232 @itemize
5233 @item
5234 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5235 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5236 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5237 @item
5238 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5239 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5240 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5241 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5242 @end itemize
5243 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5244 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5245 @end quotation
5246
5247 @end deffn
5248
5249 @section Other Flash commands
5250 @cindex flash protection
5251
5252 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5253 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5254 and display that status.
5255 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5259 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5260 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5261
5262 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5263 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5264 and possibly stale information.
5265 @end deffn
5266
5267 @anchor{flashprotect}
5268 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5269 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5270 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5271 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5272 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5273 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5275 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5276 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5277 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5278 @end deffn
5279
5280 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5281 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5282 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5283 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @anchor{program}
5287 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5288 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5289 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5290 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5291 @end deffn
5292
5293 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5294 @section Flash Driver List
5295 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5296 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5297 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5298
5299 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5300 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5301 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5302
5303 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5304
5305 @itemize
5306 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5307 @end itemize
5308
5309 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5310 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5311 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5312 @example
5313 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5314 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5315 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5316 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5317 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5318 @end example
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @subsection External Flash
5322
5323 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5324 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5325 @cindex CFI
5326 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5327 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5328 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5329 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5330 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5331 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5332 configure a bus and its timings), or
5333 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5334 on the flash chip.
5335 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5336 speed up operation.
5337
5338 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5339
5340 @itemize
5341 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5342 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5343 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5344 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5345 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5346 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5347 @end itemize
5348
5349 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5350 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5351
5352 @example
5353 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5354 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5355 @end example
5356
5357 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5358 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5359 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5360
5361 @example
5362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5363 @end example
5364
5365 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5366 @end deffn
5367
5368 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5369 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5370 @cindex SPI
5371 @cindex jtagspi
5372 @cindex bscan_spi
5373 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5374 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5375 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5376 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5377 accessed through JTAG.
5378
5379 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5380 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5381 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5382 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5383 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5384 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5385
5386 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5387 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5388 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5389 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5390 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5391 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5392 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5393 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5394
5395 @itemize
5396 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5397 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5398 @var{USER1} instruction.
5399 @end itemize
5400
5401 @example
5402 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5403 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5404 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5405 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5406 @end example
5407 @end deffn
5408
5409 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5410 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5411 @cindex xcf
5412 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5413 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5414 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5415 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5416 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5417
5418 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5419 command accepts additional parameters:
5420 @itemize
5421 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5422 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5423 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5424 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5425 in master mode.
5426 @end itemize
5427 @example
5428 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5429 @end example
5430 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5431 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5432 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5433 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5434 dedicated sector.
5435 @end deffn
5436
5437 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5438 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5439 button.
5440 @example
5441 xcf configure 0
5442 @end example
5443 @end deffn
5444
5445 Additional driver notes:
5446 @itemize
5447 @item Only single revision supported.
5448 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5449 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5450 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5451 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5452 @end itemize
5453 @end deffn
5454
5455 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5456 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5457 @cindex SPIFI
5458 @cindex lpcspifi
5459 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5460 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5461 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5462
5463 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5464 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5465 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5466 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5467 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5468
5469 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5470 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5471 are configured by the driver.
5472
5473 @example
5474 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5475 @end example
5476
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5480 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5481 @cindex SMI
5482 @cindex stmsmi
5483 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5484 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5485 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5486 SPI flash devices.
5487 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5488 flash devices can be connected.
5489
5490 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5491 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5492 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5493 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5494 the flash content.
5495
5496 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5497 to identify the memory bank.
5498 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5499 flash size, are detected automatically.
5500
5501 @example
5502 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5503 @end example
5504
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5508 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5509 Microcontroller platform.
5510
5511 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5512 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5513
5514 @example
5515 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5516 @end example
5517
5518 @end deffn
5519
5520 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5521 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5522 @cindex ath79
5523 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5524 chip selects.
5525 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5526 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5527 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5528 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5529 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5530 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5531
5532 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5533 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5534 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5535 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5536 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5537 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5538 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5539 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5540 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5541 with the default CS0.
5542 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5543 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5544 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5545
5546 @example
5547 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5548
5549 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5550 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5551 # banks.
5552 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5553 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5554 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5555 @end example
5556
5557 @end deffn
5558
5559 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5560 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5561 @cindex fespi
5562
5563 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5564
5565 @example
5566 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5567 @end example
5568 @end deffn
5569
5570 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5571
5572 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5573 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5574 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5575 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5576 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5577 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5578
5579 @example
5580 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5581 @end example
5582 @end deffn
5583
5584 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5585 @cindex ambiqmicro
5586 @cindex apollo
5587 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5588 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5589 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5590 with the target using SWD.
5591
5592 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5593 the device class of the MCU.
5594 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5595 to set up the flash banks.
5596 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5597 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5598
5599 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5600 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5601 and the second bank starts after the first.
5602
5603 @example
5604 # Flash bank 0
5605 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5606 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5607 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5608 $_TARGETNAME
5609 @end example
5610
5611 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5612 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5613 are available to the user.
5614
5615 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5616
5617 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5618 Erase entire bank.
5619 @end deffn
5620 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5621 Erase device pages.
5622 @end deffn
5623 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5624 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5625 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5626 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5627 the flash.
5628 @end deffn
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @anchor{at91samd}
5632 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5633 @cindex at91samd
5634 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5635 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5636
5637 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5638
5639 The devices have one flash bank:
5640
5641 @example
5642 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5643 @end example
5644
5645 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5646 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5647 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5648 processor to be halted.
5649 @end deffn
5650
5651 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5652 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5653 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5654 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5655 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5656 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5657
5658 @example
5659 at91samd set-security enable
5660 @end example
5661 @end deffn
5662
5663 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5664 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5665 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5666 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5667 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5668 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5669 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5670 in order to disable this feature.
5671
5672 @example
5673 at91samd eeprom
5674 at91samd eeprom 1024
5675 @end example
5676 @end deffn
5677
5678 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5679 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5680 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5681 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5682 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5683 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5684
5685 @example
5686 at91samd bootloader
5687 at91samd bootloader 16384
5688 @end example
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5692 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5693 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5694 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5695 @end deffn
5696
5697 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5698 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5699 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5700 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5701 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5702 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5703 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5704 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5705
5706 @example
5707 # Read user row
5708 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5709 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5710 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5711 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5712 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5713 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5714 @end example
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @end deffn
5718
5719 @anchor{at91sam3}
5720 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5721 @cindex at91sam3
5722 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5723 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5724 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5725 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5726 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5727 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5728 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5729 chips are confirmed.}
5730
5731 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5732 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5733 the following fixed locations:
5734
5735 @example
5736 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5738 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5740 @end example
5741
5742 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5743 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5744 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5745
5746 @itemize
5747 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5748 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5749 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5750 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5751 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5752 @end itemize
5753
5754 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5755
5756 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5757 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5758 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5759 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5760 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5761 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5762 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5763
5764 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5765 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5766 @end deffn
5767
5768 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5769 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5770 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5771 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5772 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5773 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5774 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5775 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5776 @end deffn
5777
5778 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5779 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5780 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5781 @end deffn
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5785 @cindex at91sam4
5786 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5787 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5788 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5789 @end deffn
5790
5791 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5792 @cindex at91sam4l
5793 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5794 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5795 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5796
5797 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5798 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5799 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5800 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5801 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5802 @end deffn
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @anchor{atsame5}
5806 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5807 @cindex atsame5
5808 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5809 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5810 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5811
5812 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5813 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5814 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5815
5816 @example
5817 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5818 @end example
5819
5820 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5821 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5822 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5823 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5824 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5825 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5826
5827 @example
5828 atsame5 bootloader
5829 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5830 @end example
5831 @end deffn
5832
5833 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5834 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5835 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5836 processor to be halted.
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5840 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5841 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5842 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5846 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5847 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5848 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5849 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5850 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5851 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5852 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5853
5854 @example
5855 # Read
5856 >atsame5 userpage
5857 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5858 # Write
5859 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5860 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5861 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5862 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5863 @end example
5864 @end deffn
5865
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5869 @cindex atsamv
5870 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5871 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5872 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5873 @end deffn
5874
5875 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5876 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5877 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5878 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5879 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5880
5881 @example
5882 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5883 @end example
5884
5885 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5886 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5887
5888 @itemize
5889 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5890 @item @var{banks}
5891 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5892 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5893 @item @var{pages_size}
5894 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5895 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5896 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5897 @end itemize
5898
5899 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5900 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5901 will be autoconfigured.
5902 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5903
5904 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5905 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5906 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5907 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5908 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5909
5910 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5911 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5912 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5913 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5914 are not truly general purpose).
5915 @quotation Note
5916 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5917 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5918 @end quotation
5919 @end deffn
5920 @end deffn
5921
5922 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5923 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5924 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5925 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5929 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5930 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5931 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5932
5933 @example
5934 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5935 @end example
5936
5937 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5938 each single sector one by one.
5939
5940 @example
5941 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5942 @end example
5943
5944 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5945 @end deffn
5946
5947 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5948 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5949 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5950 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5951 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5952 starts at address 0.
5953
5954 @example
5955 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5956 @end example
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5960 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5961 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5962 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5963 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5964 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5965 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5966 and programming the serial flash.
5967
5968 @example
5969 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5970 @end example
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5974 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5975 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5976 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5977 autoconfigures itself.
5978 @example
5979 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5980 @end example
5981 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5982 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5983 this via the following command:
5984 @example
5985 efm32 debuglock num
5986 @end example
5987 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5988 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5989 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5990 supported.}
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5994 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5995 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5996 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5997 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5998 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5999
6000 @example
6001 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6002 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6003 @end example
6004
6005 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6006 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6007 @end deffn
6008
6009 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6010 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6011 is an uncommon operation.}
6012 @end deffn
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6016 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6017 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6018 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6019 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6020 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6021 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6022
6023 @example
6024 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6025 @end example
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6029 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6030 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6031 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6032 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6033 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6034 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6035 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6036 characters) ignored.
6037
6038 @example
6039 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6040 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6041 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6042 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6043 @end example
6044 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6045 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6046 @end deffn
6047
6048 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6049 @cindex kinetis
6050 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6051 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6052 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6053 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6054 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6055 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6056
6057 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6058 @itemize
6059 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6060 @end itemize
6061
6062 @example
6063 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6064 @end example
6065
6066 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6067 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6068 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6069 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6070 @end deffn
6071
6072 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6073 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6074 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6075 set by 'flash protect' command.
6076 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6077 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6078 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6079 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6080 with the rest of a flash image.
6081 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6085 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6086 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6090 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6091 and examine-fail event.
6092 @end deffn
6093
6094 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6095 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6096 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6097 @end deffn
6098
6099 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6100 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6101 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6102 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6103 command completes.
6104 @end deffn
6105
6106 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6107 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6108 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6109 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6110 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6111
6112 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6113 Program Partition command.
6114
6115 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6116 Reset the device after partition setting.
6117
6118 Show partition size:
6119 @example
6120 kinetis nvm_partition info
6121 @end example
6122
6123 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6124 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6125 @example
6126 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6127 @end example
6128
6129 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6130 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6131 @example
6132 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6133 @end example
6134 @end deffn
6135
6136 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6137 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6138 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6142 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6143 Command disables watchdog timer.
6144 @end deffn
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6148 @cindex kinetis_ke
6149 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6150 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6151 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6152 autoconfigures itself.
6153 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6154
6155 @example
6156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6157 @end example
6158
6159 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6160 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6164 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6165 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6166 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6167 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6171 Command disables watchdog timer.
6172 @end deffn
6173 @end deffn
6174
6175 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6176 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6177 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6178 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6179 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6180
6181 @quotation Note
6182 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6183 driver:
6184 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6185 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6186 @end quotation
6187
6188 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6189 which must appear in the following order:
6190
6191 @itemize
6192 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6193 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6194 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6195 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6196 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6197 LPC43x[2357])
6198 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6199 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6200 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6201 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6202 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6203 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6204 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6205 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6206 at which the core is running
6207 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6208 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6209 @quotation Note
6210 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6211 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6212 However, if you do provide it,
6213 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6214 @end quotation
6215 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6216 ROM IAP entry point.
6217 @end itemize
6218
6219 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6220
6221 @example
6222 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6223 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6224 @end example
6225
6226 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6227 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6228 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6229 @end deffn
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6233 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6234 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6235 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6236 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6237 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6238
6239 @example
6240 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6241 @end example
6242 @end deffn
6243
6244 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6245 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6246 from NXP.
6247
6248 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6249 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6250 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6251 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6252 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6253 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6254 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6255 you start the PLL.
6256
6257 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6258
6259 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6260 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6261 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6262
6263 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6264 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6265 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6266 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6267 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6268 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6269 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6270
6271 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6272 @example
6273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6274 @end example
6275
6276 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6277 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6278 @code{flash banks} command.
6279
6280 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6281 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6282 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6283 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6284 a known signature.
6285 Example:
6286 @example
6287 lpc2900 signature 0
6288 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6289 @end example
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6293 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6294 saves it to a file in binary format.
6295 Example:
6296 @example
6297 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6298 @end example
6299 @end deffn
6300
6301 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6302 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6303 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6304 command:
6305
6306 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6307 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6308 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6309 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6310
6311 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6312 Example:
6313 @example
6314 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6315 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6316 @end example
6317 @end deffn
6318
6319 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6320 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6321 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6322 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6323 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6324 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6325 912 bytes.
6326 @quotation Attention
6327 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6328 @end quotation
6329 Example:
6330 @example
6331 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6332 @end example
6333 @end deffn
6334
6335 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6336 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6337 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6338 after the next power cycle.
6339 @quotation Attention
6340 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6341 @end quotation
6342 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6343 Example:
6344 @example
6345 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6346 flash info 0
6347 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6348 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6349 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6350 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6351 @end example
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6355 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6356 effective after the next power cycle.
6357 @quotation Attention
6358 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6359 @end quotation
6360 Examples:
6361 @example
6362 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6363 @end example
6364 @end deffn
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6368 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6369 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6370 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6371
6372 @example
6373 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6374 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6375 @end example
6376
6377 @itemize @bullet
6378 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6379 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6380 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6381 @end itemize
6382
6383 Example usage:
6384 @example
6385 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6386 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6387 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6388 @} else @{
6389 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6390 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6391 @}
6392 @end example
6393 @end deffn
6394
6395 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6396 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6397 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6398 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6399 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6400 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6401
6402 @example
6403 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6404 @end example
6405
6406 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6407 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6408 only the main program flash.
6409
6410 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6411 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6412 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6413 @end deffn
6414
6415 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6416 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6417 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6418 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6419
6420 To erase and program the BSL:
6421 @example
6422 msp432 bsl unlock
6423 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6424 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6425 msp432 bsl lock
6426 @end example
6427 @end deffn
6428 @end deffn
6429
6430 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6431 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6432 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6433 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6434 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6435 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6436 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6437 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6438 also have division into regions: main and info.
6439 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6440 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6441
6442 @example
6443 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6444 @end example
6445
6446 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6447
6448 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6449 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6453 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6454 @end deffn
6455
6456 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6457 Erase all userflash including info region.
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6461 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6465 Check sectors protect.
6466 @end deffn
6467
6468 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6469 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6473 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6477 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6481 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6485 Show information about flash driver.
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6491 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6492 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6493 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6494 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6495
6496 @example
6497 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6498 @end example
6499
6500 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6501
6502 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6503 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6504 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6505 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6506 code.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6510 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 @end deffn
6514
6515 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6516 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6517 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6518
6519 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6520 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6521 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6522 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6523
6524 @example
6525 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6526 @end example
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6530 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6531 and integrate flash memory.
6532
6533 @example
6534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6535 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6536 @end example
6537
6538 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6539 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6540 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6541 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6542 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6543 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6544 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6545 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6546 @end deffn
6547 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6548 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6549 This will remove any Code Protection.
6550 @end deffn
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6554 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6555 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6556 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6557 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6558
6559 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6560 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6561
6562 @example
6563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6564 @end example
6565
6566 psoc4-specific commands
6567 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6568 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6569
6570 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6571 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6572
6573 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6574 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6575 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6576
6577 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6578 @end deffn
6579
6580 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6581 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6582
6583 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6584 @end deffn
6585 @end deffn
6586
6587 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6588 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6589 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6590 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6591 apart from the base address.
6592
6593 @example
6594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6595 @end example
6596
6597 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6598 @quotation Attention
6599 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6600 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6601 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6602 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6603 @end quotation
6604
6605 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6606
6607 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6608 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6609 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6610 @end deffn
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6614 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6615 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6616 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6617 apart from the base address.
6618
6619 @example
6620 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6621 @end example
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6625 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6626 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6627 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6628
6629 @example
6630 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6631 @end example
6632
6633 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6634
6635 @itemize
6636 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6637 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6638 @end itemize
6639
6640 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6641
6642 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6643 @quotation Attention
6644 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6645 after successful write.
6646 @end quotation
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6650 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6651 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6652 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6653
6654 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6655 @itemize @bullet
6656 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6657 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6658 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6659 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6660 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6661 row size: 512 bytes.
6662 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6663 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6664 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6665 operation will erase row automatically.
6666 @end itemize
6667
6668 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6669 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6670
6671 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6672
6673 @example
6674 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6675 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6676 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6677 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6678 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6679 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6680
6681 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6682 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6683 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6684 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6685 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6686 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6687 @end example
6688
6689 psoc6-specific commands
6690 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6691 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6692 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6693 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6694 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6695 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6699 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6700 by @command{flash banks}.
6701 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6702 @end deffn
6703 @end deffn
6704
6705 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6706 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6707 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6708 and SWD interface.
6709 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6710 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6711
6712 @example
6713 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6714 @end example
6715
6716 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6717
6718 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6719 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6720 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6721 @end deffn
6722
6723 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6724 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6725 @end deffn
6726 @end deffn
6727
6728 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6729 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6730 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6731 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6732 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6733
6734 @example
6735 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6736 @end example
6737
6738 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6739 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6740 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6741 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6742 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6743 disabled.
6744
6745 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6746 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6747 @quotation Warning
6748 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6749 applied to all of them.
6750 @end quotation
6751 @end deffn
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6755 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6756 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6757 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6758 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6759
6760 @example
6761 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6762 @end example
6763
6764 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6765 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6766 the flash driver.
6767
6768 @example
6769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6770 @end example
6771
6772 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6773 as per the following example.
6774 @example
6775 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6776 @end example
6777
6778 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6779
6780 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6781 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6782 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6786 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6787 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6788 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6792 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6793 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6794 @end deffn
6795
6796 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6797 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6798 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6799 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6800 @end deffn
6801
6802 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6803 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6804 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6805 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6806 @end deffn
6807
6808 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6809 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6810 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6811 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6812 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6813 @end deffn
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6817 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6818 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6819 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6820 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6821
6822 @example
6823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6824 @end example
6825
6826 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6827 as per the following example.
6828 @example
6829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6830 @end example
6831
6832 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6833 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6834 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6838 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6839 the flash driver.
6840
6841 @example
6842 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6843 @end example
6844
6845 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6846
6847 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6848 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6849 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6853 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6854 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6858 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6859 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6863 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6864 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6868 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6869 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6870 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6871 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6872 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6876 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6877 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6878 @end deffn
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6882 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6883 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6884 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6885 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6886
6887 @example
6888 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6889 @end example
6890
6891 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6892 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6893 the flash driver.
6894
6895 @example
6896 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6897 @end example
6898
6899 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6900
6901 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6902 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6903 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6907 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6908 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6909 @end deffn
6910
6911 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6912 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6913 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6917 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6918 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6919 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6920 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6921
6922 Example usage:
6923 @example
6924 # read OPTSR_CUR
6925 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6926 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6927 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6928 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6929 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6930 @end example
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6934 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6935 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6936 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6937 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6938 will be touched).
6939
6940 Example usage:
6941 @example
6942 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6943 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6944 @end example
6945 @end deffn
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6949 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6950 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6951 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6952 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6953
6954 @example
6955 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6956 @end example
6957
6958 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6959 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6960 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6961 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6962 second bank.
6963
6964 @example
6965 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6966 @end example
6967
6968 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6969
6970 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6971 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6972 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6976 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6977 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6978 @end deffn
6979
6980 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6981 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6982 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6983 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6984 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6985 @end deffn
6986 @end deffn
6987
6988 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6989 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6990 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6991 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6992 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6993 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6994 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6995
6996 @example
6997 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6998 @end example
6999
7000 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7001 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7002 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7003 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7004
7005 @example
7006 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7007 @end example
7008
7009 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7010
7011 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7012 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7013 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7017 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7018 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7022 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7023 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7027 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7028 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7029 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7030
7031 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7032 @example
7033 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7034 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7035 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7036 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7037 @end example
7038
7039 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7040 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7044 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7045 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7046 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7047 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7048
7049 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7050 @example
7051 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7052 @end example
7053
7054 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7055 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7056 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7060 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7061 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7062 @end deffn
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7066 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7067 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7068 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7069 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7070
7071 @example
7072 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7073 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7074 @end example
7075
7076 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7077 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7078 for the specified flash bank.
7079 @end deffn
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7083 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7084 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7085 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7086 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7087
7088 @example
7089 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7090 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7091 @end example
7092
7093 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7094 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7095 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7096
7097 @itemize @bullet
7098 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7099 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7100 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7101 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7102 @end itemize
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @end deffn
7106
7107 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7108 @cindex str9xpec
7109
7110 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7111 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7112 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7113 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7114
7115 Here is some background info to help
7116 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7117 the str9:
7118 @enumerate
7119 @item
7120 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7121 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7122 @item
7123 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7124 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7125 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7126 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7127 @end enumerate
7128
7129 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7130 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7131 configured for flash bank 0.
7132 @example
7133 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7134 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7135 adapter assert srst
7136 # turn off target polling
7137 poll off
7138 # disable str9 core
7139 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7140 # read option bytes
7141 str9xpec options_read 0
7142 # re-enable str9 core
7143 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7144 poll on
7145 reset halt
7146 @end example
7147 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7148 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7149 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7150 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7151
7152 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7153
7154 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7155 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7159 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7160 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7164 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7165 erase the device.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7169 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7173 Configure str9 boot bank.
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7177 Configure str9 lvd source.
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7181 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7185 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7189 Read str9 option bytes.
7190 @end deffn
7191
7192 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7193 Write str9 option bytes.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7197 unlock str9 device.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @end deffn
7201
7202 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7203 @cindex swm050
7204 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7205
7206 @example
7207 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7208 @end example
7209
7210 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7211
7212 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7213 Erases the entire flash bank.
7214 @end deffn
7215
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218
7219 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7220 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7221 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7222 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7223
7224 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7225
7226 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7227 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7228 @end deffn
7229
7230 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7231 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7235 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7236 the flash clock.
7237 @end deffn
7238 @end deffn
7239
7240 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7241 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7242 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7243 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7244 correct bank config.
7245
7246 @example
7247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7248 @end example
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7252 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7253 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7254 @end deffn
7255
7256 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7257 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7258 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7259
7260 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7261
7262 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7263 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7267 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @section NAND Flash Commands
7273 @cindex NAND
7274
7275 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7276 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7277 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7278
7279 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7280 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7281 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7282 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7283 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7284 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7285
7286 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7287 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7288 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7289 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7290 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7291 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7292 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7293 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7294 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7295 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7296
7297 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7298 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7299 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7300 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7301 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7302 every 512 bytes of data.
7303
7304 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7305 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7306 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7307 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7308 ECC mode is used.
7309
7310 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7311 @enumerate
7312 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7313 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7314 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7315 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7316 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7317 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7318 to access that device.
7319 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7320 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7321 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7322 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7323 de-brick a board.
7324 @end enumerate
7325
7326 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7327 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7328 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7329 are only 32 bits wide.
7330 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7331 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7332 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7333 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7334
7335 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7336 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7337 @cindex NAND configuration
7338
7339 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7340 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7341 OpenOCD has initialized.
7342
7343 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7344 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7345 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7346 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7347 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7348 they were a single (larger) device.
7349 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7350 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7351
7352 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7353 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7354 configuration files, not interactively.
7355
7356 @itemize @bullet
7357 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7358 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7359 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7360 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7361 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7362 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7363 commands to the NAND controller.
7364 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7365 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7366 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7367 for more information.
7368 @end itemize
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn Command {nand list}
7372 Prints a summary of each device declared
7373 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7374 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7375 @example
7376 > nand list
7377 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7378 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7379 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7380 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7381 >
7382 @end example
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7386 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7387 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7388 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7389 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7390 it with most other NAND commands.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7394
7395 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7396 @cindex NAND reading
7397 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7398 starting at the specified offset.
7399 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7400
7401 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7402 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7403
7404 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7405 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7406 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7407
7408 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7409 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7410 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7411 method which handled that error correction.
7412
7413 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7414 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7415 @itemize @bullet
7416 @item no oob_* parameter
7417 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7418 @item @code{oob_raw}
7419 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7420 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7421 spare areas associated with each data page.
7422 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7423 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7424 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7425 @item @code{oob_only}
7426 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7427 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7428 spare areas associated with each data page.
7429 @end itemize
7430 @end deffn
7431
7432 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7433 @cindex NAND erasing
7434 @cindex NAND programming
7435 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7436 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7437 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7438 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7439 If those parameters are not specified,
7440 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7441 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7442
7443 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7444 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7445 block marker.
7446 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7447 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7448 @end deffn
7449
7450 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7451 @cindex NAND writing
7452 @cindex NAND programming
7453 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7454 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7455 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7456 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7457
7458 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7459 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7460
7461 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7462 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7463 past the end of the device.
7464 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7465 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7466 if that's being written.)
7467
7468 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7469 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7470 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7471
7472 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7473 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7474 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7475 @itemize @bullet
7476 @item no oob_* parameter
7477 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7478 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7479 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7480 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7481 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7482 @item @code{oob_only}
7483 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7484 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7485 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7486 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7487 @item @code{oob_raw}
7488 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7489 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7490 un-altered OOB.
7491 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7492 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7493 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7494 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7495 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7496 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7497 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7498 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7499 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7500 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7501 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7502 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7503 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7504 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7505 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7506 @end itemize
7507 @end deffn
7508
7509 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7510 @cindex NAND verification
7511 @cindex NAND programming
7512 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7513 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7514 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7515
7516 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7517 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7518
7519 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7520 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7521 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7522 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7523 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7524
7525 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7526 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7527 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7528
7529 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7530 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7531 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7532 be removed in a future release.
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @subsection Other NAND commands
7536 @cindex NAND other commands
7537
7538 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7539 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7540 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7541 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7542 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7543 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7544 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7545 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7546
7547 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7548 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7549 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7553 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7554 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7555 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7556 status for each block.
7557 @end deffn
7558
7559 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7560 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7561 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7562
7563 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7564 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7565 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7566 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7567 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7568
7569 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7570 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7571 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7572 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7573 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7574 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7575 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7579 @subsection NAND Driver List
7580 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7581 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7582 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7583
7584 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7585 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7586 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7587 address of the ECC controller.
7588 @example
7589 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7590 @end example
7591 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7592 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7593 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7594 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7595 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7596 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7597 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7598 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7599 @end deffn
7600 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7601 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7602 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7606 properly configured for input or output.
7607 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7608 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7609 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7610 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7611 @end deffn
7612 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7613 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7614 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7615 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7616 @end deffn
7617 @end deffn
7618
7619 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7620 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7621 chips from Texas Instruments.
7622 It takes three extra parameters:
7623 address of the NAND chip;
7624 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7625 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7626 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7627 @example
7628 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7629 @end example
7630 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7631 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7632 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7633 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7634 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7638 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7639 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7640 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7641 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7642 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7643 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7647 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7648 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7649 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7650 @end deffn
7651 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7652
7653 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7654 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7655 should work for this chip as well.
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7659 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7660 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7661 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7662 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7663 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7664 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7665 @example
7666 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7667 @end example
7668 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7669 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7670 without parameter query status.
7671 @end deffn
7672 @end deffn
7673
7674 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7675 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7676 parameter: the address of the controller.
7677 @example
7678 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7679 @end example
7680 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7681 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7682 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7683 change any behavior.
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7687 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7688 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7689 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7690 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7691 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7692 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7693 specialized commands.
7694 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7695 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7696 change any behavior.
7697 @end deffn
7698
7699 @node Flash Programming
7700 @chapter Flash Programming
7701
7702 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7703 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7704 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7705
7706 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7707 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7708
7709 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7710 @enumerate
7711 @item 'init' is executed.
7712 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7713 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7714 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7715 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7716 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7717 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7718 @end enumerate
7719
7720 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7721
7722 @example
7723 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7724 # are optional parameters
7725 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7726 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7727
7728 # binary files need the flash address passing
7729 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7730 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7731 @end example
7732
7733 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7734 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7735 @cindex PLD
7736 @cindex FPGA
7737
7738 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7739 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7740 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7741 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7742 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7743 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7744 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7745
7746 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7747
7748 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7749 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7750 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7751
7752 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7753 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7754
7755 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7756 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7757 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7758 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7759 behavior.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7763 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7767 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7768 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7772
7773 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7774 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7775 that particular type of PLD.
7776
7777 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7778 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7779 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7780
7781 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7782 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7783 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7784
7785 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7786 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7787 for FPGA @var{num}.
7788 @end deffn
7789 @end deffn
7790
7791 @node General Commands
7792 @chapter General Commands
7793 @cindex commands
7794
7795 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7796 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7797 commands are documented elsewhere.
7798
7799 Intent:
7800 @itemize @bullet
7801 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7802 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7803 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7804 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7805
7806 @item @b{From the human}
7807 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7808 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7809
7810 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7811 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7812 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7813
7814 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7815 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7816 port is 5555.
7817 @end itemize
7818
7819
7820 @section Server Commands
7821
7822 @deffn {Command} exit
7823 Exits the current telnet session.
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7827 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7828 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7829 Not every command provides helptext.
7830
7831 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7832 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7833 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7834 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7835 @end deffn
7836
7837 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7838 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7839 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7840 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7841 Useful in connection with script files
7842 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7846 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7847 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7848 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7849
7850 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7851 @example
7852 # redefine shutdown
7853 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7854 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7855 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7856 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7857 original_shutdown
7858 @}
7859 @end example
7860 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7861 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864 @anchor{debuglevel}
7865 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7866 @cindex message level
7867 Display debug level.
7868 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7869 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7870 Level 0 is error messages only;
7871 level 1 adds warnings;
7872 level 2 adds informational messages;
7873 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7874 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7875 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7876 the command line along with the location of that log
7877 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7878 @xref{Running}.
7879 @end deffn
7880
7881 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7882 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7883 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7884 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7885 @example
7886 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7887 @end example
7888 @end deffn
7889
7890 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7891 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7892 the default log output channel is stderr.
7893 @end deffn
7894
7895 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7896 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7900 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7901 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7902 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7903 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7907 @section Target State handling
7908 @cindex reset
7909 @cindex halt
7910 @cindex target initialization
7911
7912 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7913 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7914 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7915 a current target which is used to perform the
7916 various operations. The current target may be changed
7917 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7918 target which should become current.
7919
7920 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7921 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7922 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7923 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7924 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7925
7926 @emph{With no arguments}:
7927 list all available registers for the current target,
7928 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7929 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7930 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7931 are flagged as such.
7932
7933 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7934 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7935 bypassing any internal cache.
7936
7937 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7938 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7939 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7940 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7941 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7942 relevant module will flush such values.
7943
7944 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7945 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7946
7947 @example
7948 > reg
7949 ===== ARM registers
7950 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7951 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7952 (2) r2 (/32)
7953 ...
7954 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7955 >
7956 @end example
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7960 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7961 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7962 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7963 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7964 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7965 (and enter debug mode).
7966 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7967
7968 @quotation Warning
7969 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7970 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7971 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7972 power mode by gating the core clock;
7973 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7974
7975 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7976 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7977 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7978 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7979 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7980 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7981
7982 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7983 work with a JTAG debugger.
7984 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7985 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7986 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7987 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7988 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7989 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7990 @end quotation
7991
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @deffn Command resume [address]
7995 Resume the target at its current code position,
7996 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7997 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7998 @end deffn
7999
8000 @deffn Command step [address]
8001 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8002 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @anchor{resetcommand}
8006 @deffn Command reset
8007 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8008 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8009 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8010 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8011 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8012 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8013
8014 The optional parameter specifies what should
8015 happen after the reset.
8016 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8017 The other options will not work on all systems.
8018 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8019
8020 @itemize @minus
8021 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8022 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8023 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8024 @end itemize
8025 @end deffn
8026
8027 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8028 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8029 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8030 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8031 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8032 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8033 state.
8034 @end deffn
8035
8036 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8037 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8038 Set values of reset signals.
8039 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8040 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8041 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8042 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8043
8044 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8045 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8046 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8047 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8048 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8049 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8050 the signal will not be modified.
8051
8052 @quotation Note
8053 TRST is specially handled.
8054 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8055 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8056 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8057 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8058 instead of the TRST signal.
8059 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8060 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8061 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8062 with handlers for that event.
8063 @end quotation
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @section I/O Utilities
8067
8068 These commands are available when
8069 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8070 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8071 notably the ZY1000.
8072 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8073
8074 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8075
8076 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8077 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8078 the text file @file{filename}.
8079 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8080 The last string is followed by a newline.
8081 @end deffn
8082
8083 @deffn Command cat filename
8084 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8085 @end deffn
8086
8087 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8088 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8089 into @file{dest_filename}.
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092 @deffn Command ip
8093 @emph{No description provided.}
8094 @end deffn
8095
8096 @deffn Command ls
8097 @emph{No description provided.}
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn Command mac
8101 @emph{No description provided.}
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @deffn Command meminfo
8105 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8106 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8107 @end deffn
8108
8109 @deffn Command peek
8110 @emph{No description provided.}
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @deffn Command poke
8114 @emph{No description provided.}
8115 @end deffn
8116
8117 @deffn Command rm filename
8118 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8119 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8120 @end deffn
8121
8122 @deffn Command trunc filename
8123 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8124 @end deffn
8125
8126 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8127 @section Memory access commands
8128 @cindex memory access
8129
8130 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8131 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8132 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8133 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8134
8135 @enumerate
8136 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8137 to change the current target.
8138 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8139 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8140 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8141 @end enumerate
8142
8143 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8144 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8145 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8146 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8147 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8148 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8149 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8150 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8151 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8152 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8153 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8154 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8155 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8156 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8157 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8158 @end deffn
8159
8160 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8161 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8162 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8163 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8164 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8165 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8166 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8167 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8168 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8169 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8170 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8171 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @anchor{imageaccess}
8175 @section Image loading commands
8176 @cindex image loading
8177 @cindex image dumping
8178
8179 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8180 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8181 binary file named @var{filename}.
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8185 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8186 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8187 @end deffn
8188
8189 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8190 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8191 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8192 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8193 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8194 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8195 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8196 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8197 separately.
8198 @end deffn
8199
8200 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8201 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8202 The file format may optionally be specified
8203 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8204 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8205 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8206 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8207 @example
8208 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8209 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8210 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8211 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8212 $address $length
8213 @}
8214 @end example
8215 @end deffn
8216
8217 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8218 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8219 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8220 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8221 The file format may optionally be specified
8222 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8226 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8227 The file format may optionally be specified
8228 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8229 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8230 @end deffn
8231
8232 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8233 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8234 The file format may optionally be specified
8235 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8236 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8237 @end deffn
8238
8239
8240 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8241 @cindex breakpoint
8242 @cindex watchpoint
8243
8244 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8245 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8246 watchpoints.
8247 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8248
8249 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8250 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8251 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8252 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8253 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8254 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8255
8256 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8257 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8261 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8265 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8269 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8270 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8271 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8272 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8273 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8274 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8275 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8276 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8277 @end deffn
8278
8279 @section Misc Commands
8280
8281 @cindex profiling
8282 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8283 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8284 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8285 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8286 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8287 limit the address range.
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn Command {version}
8291 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8295 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8296 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8300 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8301 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8302 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8303
8304 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8305 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8306 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8307 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8308
8309 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8310 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8311 @cindex tracing
8312 @cindex ETM
8313 @cindex ETB
8314
8315 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8316 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8317 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8318
8319 @itemize
8320 @item
8321 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8322 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8323 supports such an interface.
8324 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8325 and trace port support.)
8326 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8327 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8328 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8329 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8330 in the board-specific configuration file.
8331 @item
8332 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8333 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8334 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8335 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8336 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8337 @end itemize
8338
8339 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8340
8341 @quotation Issues
8342 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8343 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8344
8345 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8346 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8347 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8348 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8349 dummy trace port driver}.
8350
8351 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8352 as well as tracing only during specific states
8353 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8354
8355 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8356 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8357 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8358 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8359 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8360
8361 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8362 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8363 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8364 this original style of JTAG access.
8365 @end quotation
8366
8367 @subsection ETM Configuration
8368 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8369
8370 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8371 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8372 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8373
8374 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8375 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8376 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8377 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8378 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8379 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8380 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8381 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8382 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8383
8384 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8385 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8386 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8387
8388 @quotation Warning
8389 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8390 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8391 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8392 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8393 @end quotation
8394
8395 @quotation Note
8396 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8397 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8398 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8399 what CPU activities are traced.
8400 @end quotation
8401 @end deffn
8402
8403 @deffn Command {etm info}
8404 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8405 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8406 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8407 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8408 @end deffn
8409
8410 @deffn Command {etm status}
8411 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8412 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8413 Did trace data overflow?
8414 Was it triggered?
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8418 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8419 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8420 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8421 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8422
8423 @itemize
8424 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8425 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8426 The value is one of
8427 @option{none} (save nothing),
8428 @option{data} (save data),
8429 @option{address} (save addresses),
8430 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8431 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8432 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8433 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8434 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8435 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8436 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8437 trace stream without an image of the code.
8438 @end itemize
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8442 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8443 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8444 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8445 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8446
8447 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8448 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8449 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8450 @end deffn
8451
8452 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8453
8454 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8455 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8456 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8457
8458 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8459 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8460 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8461 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8462 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8463 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8464 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8465
8466 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8467
8468 @itemize
8469 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8470 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8471 for instruction access within that function's body.
8472 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8473 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8474 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8475 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8476 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8477 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8478 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8479 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8480 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8481 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8482 @item @emph{... more}
8483 @end itemize
8484
8485 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8486 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8487
8488 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8489 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8490 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8494 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8495 @end deffn
8496
8497 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8498 Opens an image file.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8502 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @deffn Command {etm start}
8506 Starts trace data collection.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8510 Stops trace data collection.
8511 @end deffn
8512
8513 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8514 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8515
8516 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8517
8518 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8519 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8520 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8521 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8522 any trace data collection.}
8523 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8524 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8525 @end deffn
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8529 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8530 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8531 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8532 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8533 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8534 @end deffn
8535 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8536 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8537 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8538 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8539 trace trigger becomes active.
8540
8541 @itemize
8542 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8543 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8544 afterwards.
8545 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8546 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8547 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8548 what caused that event to happen.
8549 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8550 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8551 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8552 how the event caused trouble.
8553 @end itemize
8554 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @end deffn
8558
8559 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8560 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8561 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8562 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8563 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8564
8565 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8566 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8567
8568 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8569 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8570 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8571 @end deffn
8572
8573 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8574 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8578 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8579 @end deffn
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8583 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8584 @cindex CTI
8585
8586 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8587 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8588 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8589 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8590 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8591 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8592
8593 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8594 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8595 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8596 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8597 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8598 including additional configuration.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8602 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8603 @end deffn
8604
8605 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8606 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8610 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8611 @end deffn
8612
8613 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8614 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8618 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8622 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8623 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8624 @end deffn
8625
8626 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8627 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8628 of the CTI.
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn Command {cti names}
8632 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8633 useful in TCL scripting.
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @section Generic ARM
8637 @cindex ARM
8638
8639 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8640 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8641 commands that may be available.
8642
8643 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8644 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8645 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8646 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8647 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8648 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8649 @end deffn
8650
8651 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8652 @cindex disassemble
8653 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8654 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8655 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8656 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8657 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8658 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8659 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8660
8661 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8662 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8663 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8664 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8665 with a handful of exceptions.
8666 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8667 @end deffn
8668
8669 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8670 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8671 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8672 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8673 and using the MCR instruction.
8674 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8675 an ARM register.)
8676 @end deffn
8677
8678 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8679 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8680 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8681 and the MRC instruction.
8682 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8683 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8684 an ARM register.)
8685 @end deffn
8686
8687 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8688 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8689 core mode if necessary.
8690 @end deffn
8691
8692 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8693 @cindex ARM semihosting
8694 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8695
8696 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8697 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8698 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8699 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8700 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8701 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8705 @cindex ARM semihosting
8706 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8707
8708 @example
8709 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8710 @end example
8711
8712 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8713 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8714 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8715 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8719 @cindex ARM semihosting
8720 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8721 status.
8722
8723 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8724 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8725 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8726 debugger.
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8730 @cindex ARM semihosting
8731 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8732
8733 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8734 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8735 the value returned by the target.
8736
8737 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8738 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8739 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8740 encountering a break.
8741
8742 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8743 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8744 to the debugger.
8745 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8746 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8747 request or equivalent").
8748
8749 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8750 this option (default: disabled).
8751 @end deffn
8752
8753 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8754 @cindex ARMv4
8755 @cindex ARMv5
8756
8757 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8758 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8759 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8760 variant.
8761
8762 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8763 @cindex ARM7
8764 @cindex ARM9
8765
8766 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8767 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8768 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8769 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8770
8771 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8772 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8773 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8774 instead of breakpoints.
8775 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8776
8777 This should be
8778 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8779 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8780 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8781 @end deffn
8782
8783 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8784 @cindex DCC
8785 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8786 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8787 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8788
8789 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8790 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8791 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8795 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8796 that don't check completion of the operation.
8797 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8798
8799 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8800 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8801 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8802 @end deffn
8803
8804 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8805 @cindex ARM720T
8806
8807 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8808 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8809 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8810 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8811
8812 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8813 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8814 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8815
8816 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8817 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8818 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8822 @cindex ARM9
8823
8824 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8825 integer processors.
8826 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8827
8828 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8829 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8830 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8831 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8832
8833 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8834 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8835 @cindex vector_catch
8836 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8837 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8838 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8839 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8840 to those hardware vectors.
8841
8842 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8843 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8844 vector catch hardware to intercept
8845 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8846 @option{none} of them,
8847 or a list with one or more of the following:
8848 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8849 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8853 @cindex ARM920T
8854
8855 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8856 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8857 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8858 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8859 and ARM9 commands.
8860
8861 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8862 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8863 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8864 @end deffn
8865
8866 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8867 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8868 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8869 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8870 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8871 (Not all registers can be written.)
8872 @end deffn
8873
8874 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8875 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8876 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8877
8878 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8879 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8880 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8881 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8882 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8883 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8887 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8888 @end deffn
8889
8890 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8891 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8895 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8896
8897 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8898 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8899 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8900 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8901 and ARM9 commands.
8902
8903 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8904 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8905
8906 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8907 Print information about the caches found.
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8911 @cindex ARM966E
8912
8913 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8914 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8915 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8916 and ARM9 commands.
8917
8918 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8919 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8920 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8921 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8922 ARM966E-S TRM.
8923 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8924 as required for BIST support.
8925 @end deffn
8926
8927 @subsection XScale specific commands
8928 @cindex XScale
8929
8930 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8931
8932 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8933 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8934 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8935 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8936 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8937 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8938 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8939
8940 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8941 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8942 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8943 the mini-IC.
8944
8945 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8946 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8947 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8948 code layout in memory:
8949 @example
8950 _vectors:
8951 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8952 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8953 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8954 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8955 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8956 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8957 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8958 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8959 .org 0x100
8960 .long real_reset_vector
8961 .long real_ui_handler
8962 .long real_swi_handler
8963 .long real_pf_abort
8964 .long real_data_abort
8965 .long 0 /* unused */
8966 .long real_irq_handler
8967 .long real_fiq_handler
8968 @end example
8969
8970 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8971 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8972 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8973 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8974 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8975 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8976 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8977 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8978 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8979 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8980 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8981 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8982 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8983 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8984 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8985 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8986 software.
8987
8988 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8989 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8990 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8991 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8992
8993 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8994 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8995 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8996 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8997 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8998 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8999 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9000 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9001 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9002
9003 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9004 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9005
9006 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9007 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9008 @end deffn
9009
9010 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9011 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9015 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9019 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9020 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9024 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9028 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9032 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9036 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9037 @end deffn
9038
9039 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9040 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9041 @end deffn
9042
9043 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9044 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9045 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9046 and modifying how it is emptied.
9047 @end deffn
9048
9049 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9050 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9051 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9052 The image @var{type} may be one of
9053 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9054 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9055 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9059 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9060 @cindex vector_catch
9061 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9062 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9063
9064 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9065 @example
9066 0x01 Trap Reset
9067 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9068 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9069 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9070 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9071 0x20 reserved
9072 0x40 Trap IRQ
9073 0x80 Trap FIQ
9074 @end example
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9078 @cindex vector_table
9079
9080 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9081 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9082 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9083 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9084 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9085
9086 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9087
9088 @end deffn
9089
9090 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9091 @cindex ARMv6
9092
9093 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9094 @cindex ARM11
9095
9096 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9097 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9098 which is enabled by default.
9099 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9100 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9101 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9102 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9103 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9104 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9108 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9109 which is enabled by default.
9110 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9111 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9112 @end deffn
9113
9114 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9115 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9116 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9117 they are disabled by default.
9118 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9119 @end deffn
9120
9121 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9122 @cindex vector_catch
9123 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9124 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9125 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9126
9127 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9128 for certain hardware events.
9129 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9130 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9131 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9135 @cindex ARMv7
9136 @cindex ARMv8
9137
9138 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9139 @cindex Cortex-A
9140
9141 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9142 display information about target caches
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9146 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9147 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9148 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9149 Defaults to 'off'.
9150 @end deffn
9151
9152 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9153 Initialize core debug
9154 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9158 Display/set the current SMP mode
9159 @end deffn
9160
9161 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9162 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9166 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9170 configure l2x cache
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9174 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9175 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9176 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9177 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9178 @end deffn
9179
9180 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9181 @cindex Cortex-R
9182
9183 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9184 Initialize core debug
9185 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9189 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192
9193 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9194 @cindex tracing
9195 @cindex SWO
9196 @cindex SWV
9197 @cindex TPIU
9198 @cindex ITM
9199 @cindex ETM
9200
9201 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9202 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9203 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9204
9205 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9206 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9207 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9208 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9209
9210 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9211 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9212 debugger adapter features.
9213
9214 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9215 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9216
9217 Command options:
9218 @itemize @minus
9219 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9220 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9221 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9222 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9223 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9224 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9225 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9226 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9227 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9228 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9229 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9230 coding;
9231 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9232 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9233 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9234 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9235 data is to be output via SWO;
9236 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9237 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9238 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9239 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9240 rate automatically.
9241 @end itemize
9242
9243 Example usage:
9244 @enumerate
9245 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9246 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9247 enough to:
9248 @example
9249 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9250 ...
9251 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9252 ...
9253 @end example
9254 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9255 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9256 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9257 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9258 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9259 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9260 @example
9261 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9262 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9263 @end example
9264 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9265 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9266 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9267 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9268 @example
9269 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9270 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9271 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9272 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9273 @end example
9274 @end enumerate
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9278 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9279 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9283 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9284 @end deffn
9285
9286 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9287 @cindex Cortex-M
9288
9289 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9290 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9291
9292 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9293 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9294 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9295 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9296 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9297 the step command leaves with the core running.
9298
9299 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9300 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9301 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9302 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9303
9304 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9305 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9306 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9307 does.
9308
9309 Default is @option{auto}.
9310 @end deffn
9311
9312 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9313 @cindex vector_catch
9314 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9315 for certain hardware events.
9316
9317 Parameters request interception of
9318 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9319 @option{none} of them,
9320 or one or more of the following:
9321 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9322 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9323 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9324 @option{irq_err},
9325 @option{state_err},
9326 @option{chk_err}, or
9327 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9328 @option{reset}.
9329 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9330 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9331 are mapped to HardFault.
9332 UsageFault checks for
9333 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9334 must also be explicitly enabled.
9335
9336 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9337 @end deffn
9338
9339 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9340 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9341 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9342
9343 @itemize @minus
9344 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9345 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9346 @end itemize
9347
9348 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9349 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9350 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9351 to manually reset the peripherals.
9352 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9353
9354 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9355 instead.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9359 @cindex ARMv8-A
9360 @cindex aarch64
9361
9362 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9363 Display information about target caches
9364 @end deffn
9365
9366 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9367 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9368 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9369 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9370 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9371 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9375 @cindex disassemble
9376 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9377 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9381 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9382 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9383 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9384 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9385 @end deffn
9386
9387 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9388 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9389 @option{on}.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9393 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9394 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9395 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9396 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9397 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9401
9402 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9403 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9404
9405 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9406
9407 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9408 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9409 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9410 @end deffn
9411
9412 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9413 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9414 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9415 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9416 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9420
9421 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9422 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9423 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9424 @end deffn
9425
9426 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9427
9428 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9429 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9430 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9431 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9432 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9433 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9434 can be collected.
9435
9436 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9437 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9438 tooling.
9439
9440 @quotation Issues
9441 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9442 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9443 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9444 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9445
9446 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9447 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9448 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9449 software operation on the CPU.
9450 @end quotation
9451
9452 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9453 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9454 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9455 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9456 @end deffn
9457
9458 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9459 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9460 @end deffn
9461
9462 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9463 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9464 control is disabled.
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9468 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9469 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9470 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9471
9472 Supported trace formats:
9473 @itemize
9474 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9475 timing to be determined.
9476 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9477 addresses.
9478 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9479 @end itemize
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9483 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9484 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9485 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9486
9487 Supported conditions:
9488 @itemize
9489 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9490 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9491 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9492 instruction matches start data and mask.
9493 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9494 instruction matches start data and mask.
9495 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9496 data and mask.
9497 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9498 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9499 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9500 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9501 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9502 @end itemize
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9506 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9507 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9508 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9509
9510 Supported conditions:
9511 @itemize
9512 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9513 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9514 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9515 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9516 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9517 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9518 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9519 data and mask.
9520 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9521 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9522 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9523 @end itemize
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9527 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9528
9529 Supported triggers:
9530 @itemize
9531 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9532 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9533 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9534 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9535 collection.
9536 @end itemize
9537 @end deffn
9538
9539 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9540
9541 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9542 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9543 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9544 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9548 Display trace configuration.
9549 @end deffn
9550
9551 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9552 Display trace collection status.
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9556 Start manual trace collection.
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9560 Stop manual trace collection.
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9564 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9565 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9566 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9567 @option{size} options using DMA.
9568 @end deffn
9569
9570 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9571 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9572 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9573 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9574 @option{size} options using DMA.
9575 @end deffn
9576
9577 @section Intel Architecture
9578
9579 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9580 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9581 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9582 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9583 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9584 @itemize
9585 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9586 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9587 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9588 @end itemize
9589
9590 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9591 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9592 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9593
9594 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9595 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9596 @end deffn
9597
9598 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9599 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9603 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9604 @end deffn
9605
9606 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9607 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9611 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9612 @end deffn
9613
9614 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9615 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9619
9620 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9621 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9622
9623 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9624 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9625 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9626 @end deffn
9627 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9628 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9629
9630 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9631
9632 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9633 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9634 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9635 @end deffn
9636
9637 @subsection Registers commands
9638 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9639 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9640 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9641
9642 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9643
9644 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9645 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9646 and "timer" groups.
9647
9648 @emph{example:}
9649 @example
9650 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9651 @end example
9652
9653
9654 @end deffn
9655 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9656 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9657
9658 @emph{group} can be "system",
9659 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9660 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9661 @end deffn
9662
9663 @section RISC-V Architecture
9664
9665 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9666 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9667 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9668 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9669 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9670 implement version 0.11.
9671
9672 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9673
9674 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9675 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9676 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9677
9678 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9679
9680 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9681 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9682 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9683
9684 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9685 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9686 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9687 CSRs.
9688 @end deffn
9689
9690 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9691 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9692 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9693 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9694 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9695 This command must be executed before `init`.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9699 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9700 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9701 @end deffn
9702
9703 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9704 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9705 deasserted.
9706 @end deffn
9707
9708 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9709 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9710 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9711 @end deffn
9712
9713 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9714 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9715 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9716 @end deffn
9717
9718 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9719 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9720 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9721 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9722 values.
9723
9724 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9725 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9726 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9727 @end deffn
9728
9729 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9730
9731 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9732 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9733 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9734 @example
9735 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9736 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9737 @end example
9738
9739 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9740 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9744 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9745 @end deffn
9746
9747 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9748
9749 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9750 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9751
9752 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9753 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9754 @end deffn
9755
9756 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9757 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @section ARC Architecture
9761 @cindex ARC
9762
9763 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9764 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9765 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9766 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9767 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9768 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9769 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9770 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9771 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9772 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9773 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9774 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9775 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9776 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9777 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9778
9779
9780 @subsection General ARC commands
9781
9782 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9783
9784 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9785 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9786 arguments:
9787
9788 @itemize @bullet
9789
9790 @item @code{-name} name
9791 @*Name of a register.
9792
9793 @item @code{-num} number
9794 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9795
9796 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9797 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9798
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9802
9803 @itemize @bullet
9804
9805 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9806 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9807 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9808 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9809 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9810 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9811
9812 @item @code{-core}
9813 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9814 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9815 spaces.
9816
9817 @item @code{-bcr}
9818 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9819 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9820 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9821 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
9822 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
9823
9824 @item @code{-type} type_name
9825 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
9826 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
9827
9828 @item @code{-g}
9829 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
9830 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
9831 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
9832 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
9833 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
9834
9835 @end itemize
9836
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
9840 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
9841 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
9842 @end deffn
9843
9844 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
9845 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
9846 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
9847 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
9848 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
9849 startbit endbit}.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
9853 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
9854 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
9855 @end deffn
9856
9857 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
9858 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
9859 as an argument for a single command invocation.
9860 @end deffn
9861
9862 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
9863
9864 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
9865 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
9866 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9867 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9868
9869 @end deffn
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
9872 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
9873 registers.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
9877 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
9878 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9879 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9880
9881 @end deffn
9882
9883 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
9884 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
9885 registers.
9886 @end deffn
9887
9888 @section STM8 Architecture
9889 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
9890 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
9891
9892 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
9893 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
9894
9895 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9896 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9897 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9898 @cindex tracing
9899 @cindex libdcc
9900 @cindex DCC
9901 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9902 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9903 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9904 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9905
9906 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9907 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9908 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9909 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9910 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9911 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9912
9913 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9914 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9915 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9916 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9917 The target being debugged may
9918 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9919 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9920 each supported by a command:
9921
9922 @itemize
9923 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9924 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9925 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9926 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9927
9928 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9929 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9930 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9931
9932 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9933 and then displayed at any time.
9934 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9935
9936 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9937 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9938 @end itemize
9939
9940 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9941 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9942 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9943 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9944 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9945 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9946 does the same thing.
9947
9948 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9949 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9950 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9951 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9952 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9953
9954 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9955 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9956 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9957 @end deffn
9958
9959 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9960 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9961 in the order they triggered.
9962 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9963 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9964 history records.
9965 @end deffn
9966
9967 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9968 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9969 they have been triggered.
9970 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9971 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9972 and associates it with that identifier.
9973
9974 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9975 are not related except by this command.
9976 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9977 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9978 @end deffn
9979
9980
9981 @node JTAG Commands
9982 @chapter JTAG Commands
9983 @cindex JTAG Commands
9984 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9985 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9986 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9987 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9988 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9989
9990 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9991 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9992
9993 @itemize @bullet
9994 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9995 devices such as a CPUs.
9996 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9997 standard state machine (in parallel)
9998 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9999 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10000 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10001 while the reading previous ones.
10002 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10003 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10004 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10005 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10006 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10007 registers.
10008 @end itemize
10009
10010 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10011
10012 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10013 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10014 the order of TAP state transitions.
10015 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10016 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10017 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10018 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10019 these commands are not available.
10020
10021 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10022 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10023 that specify the entire register.
10024 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10025 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10026 The return value holds the original value of each
10027 of those fields.
10028
10029 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10030 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10031 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10032 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10033 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10034
10035 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10036 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10037
10038 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10039 in that state.
10040 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10041 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10042 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10043
10044 @quotation Warning
10045 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10046 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10047 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10048 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10049 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10050 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10051 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10052 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10053 @end quotation
10054 @end deffn
10055
10056 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10057 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10058 This may be used for performance tuning.
10059
10060 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10061 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10062 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10063 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10064 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10065 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10066 @end deffn
10067
10068 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10069 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10070 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10071 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10072 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10073 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10074
10075 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10076 in that state.
10077 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10078 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10079 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10080
10081 @quotation Note
10082 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10083 register values, unlike data register values.
10084 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10085 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10086 @end quotation
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10090 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10091 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10092 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10093 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10094 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10095 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10096 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10097 The final state must also be stable.
10098 @end deffn
10099
10100 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10101 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10102 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10103 Instructions often need some time
10104 to execute before they take effect.
10105 @end deffn
10106
10107 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10108 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10109
10110 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10111 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10112 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10113 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10114 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10115 @end deffn
10116
10117 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10118 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10119 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10120 must also be enabled.
10121 Default is enabled.
10122 @end deffn
10123
10124 @section TAP state names
10125 @cindex TAP state names
10126
10127 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10128 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10129 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10130 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10131
10132 @itemize @bullet
10133 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10134 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10135 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10136 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10137 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10138 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10139 through the data register
10140 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10141 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10142 for update or more shifting
10143 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10144 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10145 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10146 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10147 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10148 through the instruction register
10149 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10150 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10151 for update or more shifting
10152 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10153 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10154 @end itemize
10155
10156 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10157 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10158 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10159 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10160
10161 @itemize @bullet
10162 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10163 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10164 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10165 may not be as expected.
10166 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10167 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10168 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10169 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10170 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10171 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10172 @end itemize
10173
10174 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10175 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10176
10177 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10178 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10179 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10180 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10181
10182 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10183 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10184 @cindex SVF
10185
10186 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10187 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10188 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10189 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10190
10191 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10192 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10193 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10194 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10195
10196 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10197 affect their semantics.
10198
10199 Command options:
10200 @itemize @minus
10201 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10202 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10203 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10204 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10205 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10206 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10207 on the real interface;
10208 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10209 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10210 errors.
10211 @end itemize
10212 @end deffn
10213
10214 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10215 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10216 @cindex XSVF
10217
10218 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10219 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10220 Xilinx devices.
10221 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10222 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10223
10224 @quotation Important
10225 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10226 @end quotation
10227
10228 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10229 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10230 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10231 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10232 that TAP.
10233 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10234 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10235 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10236 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10237 @end deffn
10238
10239 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10240 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10241 after building the software.
10242 You may find them useful:
10243
10244 @itemize
10245 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10246 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10247 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10248 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10249 @end itemize
10250
10251 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10252 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10253 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10254 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10255 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10256 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10257 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10258
10259
10260 @node Utility Commands
10261 @chapter Utility Commands
10262 @cindex Utility Commands
10263
10264 @section RAM testing
10265 @cindex RAM testing
10266
10267 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10268 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10269 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10270 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10271 hardware problems.
10272
10273 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10274 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10275 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10276 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10277
10278 Load the memory testing functions with
10279
10280 @example
10281 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10282 @end example
10283
10284 to get access to the following facilities:
10285
10286 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10287 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10288 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10289 @end deffn
10290
10291 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10292 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10293 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10294 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10295 @end deffn
10296
10297 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10298 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10299 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10300 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10301 @end deffn
10302
10303 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10304 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10305 @end deffn
10306
10307 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10308 @cindex Firmware recovery
10309
10310 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10311 devices recovery with JTAG.
10312
10313 For quickstart instructions run:
10314 @example
10315 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10316 @end example
10317
10318 @node TFTP
10319 @chapter TFTP
10320 @cindex TFTP
10321 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10322 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10323
10324 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10325 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10326 server (tftpd). For example,
10327
10328 @example
10329 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10330 @end example
10331
10332 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10333 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10334
10335 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10336 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10337 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10338 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10339
10340 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10341 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10342 @cindex GDB
10343 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10344 to debug remote targets.
10345 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10346
10347 @itemize
10348 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10349 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10350 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10351 as shown in this chapter.
10352 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10353 that also will probably need to be configured.
10354 @end itemize
10355
10356 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10357 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10358 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10359 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10360 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10361 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10362
10363 @section Connecting to GDB
10364 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10365 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10366 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10367 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10368 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10369
10370 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10371
10372 @enumerate
10373 @item
10374 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10375 @example
10376 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10377 @end example
10378 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10379
10380 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10381 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10382 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10383
10384 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10385 remote command above that becomes:
10386 @example
10387 tar ext :3333
10388 @end example
10389
10390 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10391 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10392 available through the command:
10393 @example
10394 target remote localhost:3333
10395 @end example
10396
10397 @item
10398 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10399 @example
10400 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10401 @end example
10402 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10403 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10404 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10405 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10406 @end enumerate
10407
10408 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10409 GDB command line.
10410
10411 @section Sample GDB session startup
10412
10413 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10414 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10415 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10416 small ARM program.
10417 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10418 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10419
10420 @example
10421 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10422 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10423 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10424 ...
10425 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10426 ...
10427 (gdb) load
10428 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10429 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10430 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10431 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10432 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10433 (gdb) continue
10434 Continuing.
10435 ...
10436 @end example
10437
10438 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10439 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10440 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10441 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10442
10443 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10444
10445 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10446 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10447 packet size and the device's memory map.
10448 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10449 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10450 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10451
10452 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10453 You may need to set those up by hand.
10454 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10455 something like:
10456
10457 @example
10458 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10459 @end example
10460
10461 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10462
10463 @example
10464 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10465 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10466 @end example
10467
10468 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10469 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10470 do not have such restrictions.
10471
10472 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10473 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10474 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10475 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10476
10477 @section Programming using GDB
10478 @cindex Programming using GDB
10479 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10480
10481 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10482 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10483 @example
10484 gdb_memory_map disable
10485 @end example
10486 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10487 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10488 working area.
10489
10490 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10491 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10492 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10493 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10494
10495 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10496 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10497
10498 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10499 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10500 @example
10501 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10502 @end example
10503
10504 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10505 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10506
10507 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10508 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10509 will be used.
10510
10511 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10512 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10513 @example
10514 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10515 @end example
10516 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10517
10518 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10519 can be used.
10520
10521 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10522 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10523 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10524
10525 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10526 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10527 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10528
10529 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10530 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10531 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10532 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10533 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10534 without any intrusion of the target process.
10535
10536 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10537 Place following command after target configuration:
10538 @example
10539 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10540 @end example
10541
10542 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10543 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10544 @example
10545 gdb_memory_map disable
10546 @end example
10547
10548 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10549 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10550 @example
10551 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10552 @end example
10553
10554 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10555 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10556
10557 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10558 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10559 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10560 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10561
10562 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10563 previously shown varibles.
10564
10565 @section RTOS Support
10566 @cindex RTOS Support
10567 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10568
10569 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10570 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10571
10572 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10573 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10574 GDB commands.
10575
10576 @* An example setup is below:
10577
10578 @example
10579 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10580 @end example
10581
10582 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10583
10584 Currently supported rtos's include:
10585 @itemize @bullet
10586 @item @option{eCos}
10587 @item @option{ThreadX}
10588 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10589 @item @option{linux}
10590 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10591 @item @option{embKernel}
10592 @item @option{mqx}
10593 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10594 @item @option{nuttx}
10595 @item @option{RIOT}
10596 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10597 @end itemize
10598
10599 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10600 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10601
10602 @table @code
10603 @item eCos symbols
10604 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10605 @item ThreadX symbols
10606 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10607 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10608 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10609 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10610 @tex
10611 \begingroup
10612 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10613 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10614 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10615 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10616 \par
10617 \endgroup
10618 @end tex
10619 @item linux symbols
10620 init_task.
10621 @item ChibiOS symbols
10622 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10623 @item embKernel symbols
10624 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10625 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10626 @item mqx symbols
10627 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10628 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10629 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10630 @item nuttx symbols
10631 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10632 @item RIOT symbols
10633 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10634 @end table
10635
10636 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10637 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10638
10639 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10640 along with the project:
10641
10642 @table @code
10643 @item FreeRTOS
10644 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10645 @item uC/OS-III
10646 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10647 @end table
10648
10649 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10650 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10651 @cindex SMP
10652 @cindex RTOS
10653 @cindex hwthread
10654 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10655 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10656 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10657 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10658 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10659 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10660 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10661 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10662 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10663
10664 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10665 @quotation Note
10666 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10667 @end quotation
10668
10669 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10670 @itemize @bullet
10671 @item j - smp status request
10672 @item J - smp set request
10673 @end itemize
10674
10675 OpenOCD implements :
10676 @itemize @bullet
10677 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10678 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10679 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10680 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10681 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10682 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10683 @end itemize
10684
10685 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10686 @itemize @bullet
10687 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10688 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10689 @example
10690 set $_core 1
10691 #Jc01 packet is sent
10692 print $_core
10693 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10694 @end example
10695
10696 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10697 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10698
10699 @example
10700 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10701 define toggle0
10702 maint packet Jc0
10703 continue
10704 main packet Jc-1
10705 end
10706 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10707 define toggle1
10708 maint packet Jc1
10709 continue
10710 main packet Jc-1
10711 end
10712 @end example
10713 @end itemize
10714
10715 @node Tcl Scripting API
10716 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10717 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10718 @cindex Tcl scripts
10719 @section API rules
10720
10721 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10722 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10723 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10724
10725 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10726 pair list and lists.
10727
10728 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10729 list.
10730
10731 @example
10732 > set foo(me) Duane
10733 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10734 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10735 > set foo(duck) Donald
10736 @end example
10737
10738 If one does this:
10739
10740 @example
10741 > set foo
10742 @end example
10743
10744 The result is:
10745
10746 @example
10747 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10748 @end example
10749
10750 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10751
10752 @verbatim
10753 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10754 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10755 }
10756 @end verbatim
10757
10758 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10759 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10760
10761 @section Internal low-level Commands
10762
10763 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10764 invoke directly.
10765
10766 @itemize @bullet
10767 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10768
10769 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10770 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10771
10772 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10773 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10774
10775 Return information about the flash banks
10776
10777 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10778
10779 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10780 its execution. Example:
10781
10782 @example
10783 > capture "reset init"
10784 @end example
10785
10786 @end itemize
10787
10788 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10789 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10790 called "flash_banks".
10791
10792 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10793
10794 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10795 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10796 holds one of the following values:
10797
10798 @itemize @bullet
10799 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10800 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10801 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10802 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10803 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10804 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10805 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10806 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10807 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10808 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10809 @end itemize
10810
10811 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10812
10813 @quotation Note
10814 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10815 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10816 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10817 is jim, not real tcl).
10818 @end quotation
10819
10820 @section Tcl RPC server
10821 @cindex RPC
10822
10823 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10824 commands and receive the results.
10825
10826 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10827 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10828 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10829 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10830 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10831
10832 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10833 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10834 @command{capture} command.
10835
10836 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10837
10838 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10839 @cindex RPC Notifications
10840
10841 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10842 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10843
10844 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10845 in the following format.
10846
10847 @verbatim
10848 type target_event event [event-name]
10849 type target_state state [state-name]
10850 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10851 @end verbatim
10852
10853 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10854 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10855 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10856 Defaults to off.
10857
10858 @end deffn
10859
10860 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10861 @cindex RPC trace output
10862
10863 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10864 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10865
10866 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10867
10868 @verbatim
10869 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10870 @end verbatim
10871
10872 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10873 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10874 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10875 Defaults to off.
10876
10877 See an example application here:
10878 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10879
10880 @end deffn
10881
10882 @node FAQ
10883 @chapter FAQ
10884 @cindex faq
10885 @enumerate
10886 @anchor{faqrtck}
10887 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10888 @cindex RTCK
10889 @cindex adaptive clocking
10890 @*
10891
10892 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10893 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10894 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10895 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10896
10897 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10898 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10899 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10900 @enumerate
10901 @item
10902 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10903 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10904 @item
10905 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10906 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10907 @end enumerate
10908
10909 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10910 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10911 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10912 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10913 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10914 power).
10915
10916 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10917 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10918 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10919 ARM926 scenario).
10920 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10921 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10922 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10923
10924 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10925 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10926 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10927 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10928
10929 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10930
10931 In order to make use of this,
10932 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10933 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10934
10935 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10936 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10937 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10938 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10939 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10940
10941 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10942 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10943 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10944 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10945
10946 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10947 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10948 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10949 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10950 with a CPLD.
10951 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10952 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10953 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10954 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10955 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10956 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10957
10958 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10959
10960 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10961
10962 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10963 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10964 depending on the chips on your board.
10965 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10966 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10967 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10968
10969 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10970 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10971 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10972
10973 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10974 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10975 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10976 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10977
10978 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10979 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10980 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10981 this way.
10982
10983 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10984 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10985 clock rate.
10986 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10987 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10988 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10989
10990 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10991
10992 @example
10993 # Example: 1.234MHz
10994 adapter speed 1234
10995 @end example
10996
10997
10998 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10999
11000 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11001 around Windows filenames.
11002
11003 @example
11004 > echo \a
11005
11006 > echo @{\a@}
11007 \a
11008 > echo "\a"
11009
11010 >
11011 @end example
11012
11013
11014 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11015
11016 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11017 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11018 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11019
11020 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11021 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11022 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11023
11024 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11025 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11026 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11027
11028 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11029
11030 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11031 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11032 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11033 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11034
11035 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11036 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11037 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11038
11039 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11040 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11041
11042 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11043 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11044 memory read caused data abort".
11045
11046 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11047 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11048 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11049 be done, feel free to add this here.
11050
11051 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11052 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11053 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11054 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11055 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11056 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11057 gracefully stops.
11058
11059 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11060 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11061 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11062
11063 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11064 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11065 bytes. Painful...
11066
11067
11068 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11069 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11070
11071 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11072 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11073 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11074 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11075 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11076 reset, everything else should work fine.
11077
11078 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11079 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11080 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11081 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11082
11083 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11084 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11085 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11086 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11087
11088 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11089
11090 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11091 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11092 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11093
11094 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11095 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11096
11097 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11098 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11099 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11100 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11101 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11102 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11103 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11104 clock frequency?
11105
11106 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11107 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11108 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11109 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11110 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11111
11112 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11113
11114 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11115 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11116 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11117 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11118 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11119 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11120 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11121
11122 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11123
11124 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11125 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11126 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11127 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11128
11129 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11130 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11131 particular order?
11132
11133 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11134 the same order used by the hardware.
11135
11136 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11137 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11138 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11139 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11140 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11141 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11142
11143 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11144 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11145 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11146 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11147
11148 @itemize @bullet
11149 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11150 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11151 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11152 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11153 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11154 @end itemize
11155
11156 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11157
11158 @itemize @bullet
11159 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11160 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11161 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11162 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11163 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11164 @end itemize
11165
11166
11167 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11168 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11169 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11170
11171 TODO.
11172
11173 @end enumerate
11174
11175 @node Tcl Crash Course
11176 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11177 @cindex Tcl
11178
11179 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11180 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11181 how the Tcl scripts work.
11182
11183 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11184 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11185 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11186 OpenOCD.
11187
11188 @section Tcl Rule #1
11189 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11190 @enumerate
11191 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11192 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11193 @end enumerate
11194
11195 The Tcl equal is this:
11196
11197 @enumerate
11198 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11199 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11200 @end enumerate
11201
11202 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11203 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11204
11205 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11206 There is a second pair of rules.
11207 @enumerate
11208 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11209 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11210 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11211 in Tcl.
11212 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11213 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11214 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11215 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11216 @end enumerate
11217
11218 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11219 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11220 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11221 Everything is a string}
11222
11223 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11224 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11225 difference is subtle.
11226 @enumerate
11227 @item Parse Time
11228 @item Evaluation Time
11229 @end enumerate
11230
11231 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11232 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11233 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11234
11235 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11236 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11237 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11238 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11239
11240 @itemize @bullet
11241 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11242 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11243 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11244 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11245 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11246 @example
11247 # bash example
11248 X=`date`
11249 echo "The Date is: $X"
11250 # Tcl example
11251 set X [date]
11252 puts "The Date is: $X"
11253 @end example
11254 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11255 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11256 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11257 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11258 is a string}
11259 @example
11260 set x "Dinner"
11261 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11262 @end example
11263 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11264 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11265 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11266 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11267 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11268 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11269 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11270 @end itemize
11271
11272 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11273
11274 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11275
11276 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11277
11278 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11279 the normal way.
11280
11281 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11282 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11283 line is immediately executed.
11284
11285 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11286 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11287
11288 @subsection Command Execution
11289
11290 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11291 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11292 control flow operators.
11293
11294 Commands are executed like this:
11295
11296 @enumerate
11297 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11298 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11299 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11300 @end enumerate
11301
11302 It sort of works like this:
11303 @example
11304 for(;;)@{
11305 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11306
11307 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11308
11309 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11310 @}
11311 @end example
11312
11313 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11314 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11315 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11316 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11317 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11318 ``LookupCommand()''
11319
11320 @subsection The FOR command
11321
11322 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11323 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11324 command just like any other command.
11325
11326 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11327 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11328 are:
11329
11330 @enumerate 0
11331 @item The ascii text 'for'
11332 @item The start text
11333 @item The test expression
11334 @item The next text
11335 @item The body text
11336 @end enumerate
11337
11338 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11339 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11340 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11341 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11342
11343 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11344 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11345
11346 @example
11347 int
11348 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11349 int *argc,
11350 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11351 @end example
11352
11353 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11354 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11355 still operates in the same basic way.
11356
11357 @subsection FOR command implementation
11358
11359 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11360 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11361
11362 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11363
11364 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11365
11366 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11367 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11368 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11369
11370 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11371 expression and returns a value.
11372
11373 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11374 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11375 @example
11376 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11377
11378 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11379
11380 int
11381 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11382 int argc,
11383 char **argv )
11384 @{
11385 if( argc != 5 )@{
11386 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11387 return ERROR;
11388 @}
11389
11390 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11391
11392 // Execute the start statement.
11393 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11394
11395 // Top of loop test
11396 for(;;)@{
11397 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11398 if( i == 0 )
11399 break;
11400
11401 // Execute the body
11402 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11403
11404 // Execute the LOOP part
11405 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11406 @}
11407
11408 // Return no error
11409 SetResult( interp, "" );
11410 return SUCCESS;
11411 @}
11412 @end example
11413
11414 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11415 in the same basic way.
11416
11417 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11418
11419 @subsection source and find commands
11420 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11421 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11422 @*Remember the parsing rules
11423 @enumerate
11424 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11425 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11426 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11427 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11428 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11429 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11430 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11431 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11432 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11433 @end enumerate
11434 @subsection format command
11435 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11436 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11437 @b{sprintf()}.
11438 @b{Example}
11439 @example
11440 set x 6
11441 set y 7
11442 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11443 @end example
11444 @enumerate
11445 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11446 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11447 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11448 @* Refer to Rule #1
11449 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11450 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11451 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11452 @end enumerate
11453 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11454 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11455 @example
11456 #1 Good
11457 proc someproc @{@} @{
11458 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11459 @}
11460 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11461 #2 Good - no variables
11462 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11463 #3 Good Curly Braces
11464 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11465 puts "Time: [date]"
11466 @}
11467 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11468 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11469 @end example
11470 @enumerate
11471 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11472 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11473 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11474 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11475 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11476 command.
11477 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11478 @*There are 4 examples:
11479 @enumerate
11480 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11481 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11482 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11483 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11484 @end enumerate
11485
11486 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11487 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11488 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11489
11490 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11491 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11492 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11493 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11494 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11495 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11496 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11497 @end enumerate
11498 @subsection Global Variables
11499 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11500 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11501 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11502 @example
11503 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11504 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11505 global x #Global variable X
11506 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11507 @}
11508 @end example
11509 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11510 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11511 @example
11512 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11513 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11514 # Create var name
11515 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11516 # Make it a global
11517 global $vn
11518 # Set it.
11519 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11520 @}
11521 @end example
11522 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11523 @example
11524 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11525 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11526 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11527 @}
11528 @end example
11529
11530 @include fdl.texi
11531
11532 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11533 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11534 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11535 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11536 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11537 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11538
11539 @printindex cp
11540
11541 @node Command and Driver Index
11542 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11543 @printindex fn
11544
11545 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)